blob: 9fbffbaafd89a85f14f0bf97e0f15dca8716ee02 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8747b6d2015-03-11 23:57:23 +01007 2015/03/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020053
544. Proxies
554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
564.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
57
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200585. Bind and Server options
595.1. Bind options
605.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020061
626. HTTP header manipulation
63
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200647. Using ACLs and fetching samples
657.1. ACL basics
667.1.1. Matching booleans
677.1.2. Matching integers
687.1.3. Matching strings
697.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
707.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
717.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
727.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
737.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200747.3.1. Converters
757.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
767.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
777.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
787.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
797.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200807.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081
828. Logging
838.1. Log levels
848.2. Log formats
858.2.1. Default log format
868.2.2. TCP log format
878.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100888.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100898.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200908.3. Advanced logging options
918.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
928.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
938.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
948.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
958.4. Timing events
968.5. Session state at disconnection
978.6. Non-printable characters
988.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
998.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1008.9. Examples of logs
101
1029. Statistics and monitoring
1039.1. CSV format
1049.2. Unix Socket commands
105
106
1071. Quick reminder about HTTP
108----------------------------
109
110When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
111fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
112on almost anything found in the contents.
113
114However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
115formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
116correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
117
118
1191.1. The HTTP transaction model
120-------------------------------
121
122The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100123to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
125connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
126will involve a new connection :
127
128 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
129
130In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
131establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
132by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
133length.
134
135Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
136to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
137however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
138response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
139header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
144power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
145but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200146a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147
148A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
149keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
150second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
151page :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
156latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
157correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
158the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100159server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100161By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
162connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
163leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
164start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
167 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
168 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
169 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
170 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
171 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
172 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174
1751.2. HTTP request
176-----------------
177
178First, let's consider this HTTP request :
179
180 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100181 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
183 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
184 3 User-agent: my small browser
185 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
186 5 Accept: image/png
187
188
1891.2.1. The Request line
190-----------------------
191
192Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
193
194 - a METHOD : GET
195 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
197
198All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
199which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
200followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
201is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
202desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
203the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
204
205The URI itself can have several forms :
206
207 - A "relative URI" :
208
209 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
210
211 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
212 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
213
214 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
215
216 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
217
218 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
219 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
220 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
221 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
222 must accept this form too.
223
224 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
225 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
226 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
229 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
230 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
231 other protocols too.
232
233In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
234mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
235on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
236It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
237specific to the language, framework or application in use.
238
239
2401.2.2. The request headers
241--------------------------
242
243The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
244beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
245an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
246Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
247values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
248encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
249the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
250define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
251
252Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
253their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
254"Connection:" header).
255
256The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
257that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
258is one valid form of empty line.
259
260Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
261headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
262about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
263application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
264
265Important note:
266 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
267 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
268 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
269 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
270
271
2721.3. HTTP response
273------------------
274
275An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
276messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
277
278 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100279 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
281 2 Content-length: 350
282 3 Content-Type: text/html
283
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
285codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
286response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100287continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
288the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
289following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
290sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
291(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
292correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
293such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
294state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
295over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
296if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
297information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
3001.3.1. The Response line
301------------------------
302
303Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
304
305 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
306 - a status code : 200
307 - a reason : OK
308
309The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200310 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
312 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
313 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
314 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
315
316Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
319messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
320or "Authentication Required".
321
322Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
323
324 Code When / reason
325 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
326 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
327 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100329 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331 400 for an invalid or too large request
332 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
333 accessing the stats page)
334 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
335 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
336 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
337 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
338 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
339 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
340 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
341 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
342 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
343
344The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3454.2).
346
347
3481.3.2. The response headers
349---------------------------
350
351Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
352the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
353details.
354
355
3562. Configuring HAProxy
357----------------------
358
3592.1. Configuration file format
360------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200361
362HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
363
364 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
365 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
366 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
367 "frontend" and "backend".
368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
370referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200371delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003742.2. Quoting and escaping
375-------------------------
376
377HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
378many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
379with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
380single quotes.
381
382If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
383them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
384escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
385
386Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
387
388 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
389 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
390 \\ to use a backslash
391 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
392 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
393
394Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
395the interpretation of:
396
397 space as a parameter separator
398 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
399 # hash as a comment start
400
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200401Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
402-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
403backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
404
405Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200406quoting.
407
408Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
409nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
410
411Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
412equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
413
414 Example:
415 # those are equivalents:
416 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
417 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
418 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
419 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
421
422 # those are equivalents:
423 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
424 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
425 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
426 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
427
428
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004292.3. Environment variables
430--------------------------
431
432HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
433interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
434configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
435optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
436shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
437underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
438
439 Example:
440
441 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
442
443 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
444
445 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
446
447
4482.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200449----------------
450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100451Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100452values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
453otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
454numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
455for every keyword. Supported units are :
456
457 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
458 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
459 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
460 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
461 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
462 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
463
464
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004652.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200466-------------
467
468 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
469 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
470 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
471 global
472 daemon
473 maxconn 256
474
475 defaults
476 mode http
477 timeout connect 5000ms
478 timeout client 50000ms
479 timeout server 50000ms
480
481 frontend http-in
482 bind *:80
483 default_backend servers
484
485 backend servers
486 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
487
488
489 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
490 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
491 global
492 daemon
493 maxconn 256
494
495 defaults
496 mode http
497 timeout connect 5000ms
498 timeout client 50000ms
499 timeout server 50000ms
500
501 listen http-in
502 bind *:80
503 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
504
505
506Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
507
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100508 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200509
510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005113. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200512--------------------
513
514Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
515are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
516of them have command-line equivalents.
517
518The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
519
520 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200522 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200523 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200524 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900525 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - gid
527 - group
528 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100529 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - nbproc
531 - pidfile
532 - uid
533 - ulimit-n
534 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200535 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100536 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200537 - node
538 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100539 - unix-bind
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100540 - 51degrees-data-file
541 - 51degrees-property-name-list
542 - 51degrees-property-seperator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100543
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200545 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200547 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100548 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100549 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100550 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200551 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200552 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200553 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554 - noepoll
555 - nokqueue
556 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100557 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300558 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200559 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200560 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200561 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100562 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100563 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200564 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100565 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100566 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100567 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100568 - tune.lua.session-timeout
569 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100570 - tune.maxaccept
571 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200572 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200573 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200574 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100575 - tune.rcvbuf.client
576 - tune.rcvbuf.server
577 - tune.sndbuf.client
578 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100579 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100580 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200581 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100582 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200583 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200584 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100585 - tune.zlib.memlevel
586 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100587
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 * Debugging
589 - debug
590 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591
592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005933.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594------------------------------------
595
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200596ca-base <dir>
597 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200598 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
599 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601chroot <jail dir>
602 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
603 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
604 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
605 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
606 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
607 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100608
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100609cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
610 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
611 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
612 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100613 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
614 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
615 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
616 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
617 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
618 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
619 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
620 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
621 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
622 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100623
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200624crt-base <dir>
625 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
626 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
627 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
628
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200629daemon
630 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
631 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
632 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
633
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200634deviceatlas-json-file <path>
635 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
636 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
637
638deviceatlas-log-level <value>
639 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
640 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
641
642deviceatlas-separator <char>
643 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
644 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
645
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900646external-check
647 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
648 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
649 See "option external-check".
650
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200651gid <number>
652 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
653 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
654 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100655 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
656 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100658
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200659group <group name>
660 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
661 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100662
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200663log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200664 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
665 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100666 configured with "log global".
667
668 <address> can be one of:
669
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100670 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100671 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
672 port).
673
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100674 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
675 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
676 port).
677
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100678 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
679 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
680 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
681 writeable).
682
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200683 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
684 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100685
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200686 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
687 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
688 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
689 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
690 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
691 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
692 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
693 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
694 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
695 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
696 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
697
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100698 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699
700 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
701 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
702 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
703
704 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200705 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
706 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
707 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
708 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
709 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
710 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200711
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200712 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100714log-send-hostname [<string>]
715 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
716 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
717 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
718 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
719 the logs.
720
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000721log-tag <string>
722 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
723 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
724 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100725 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000726
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100727lua-load <file>
728 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
729 used multiple times.
730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731nbproc <number>
732 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
733 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
734 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
735 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
736 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
737
738pidfile <pidfile>
739 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
740 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
741 starting the process. See also "daemon".
742
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100743stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200744 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
745 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
746 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
747 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
748 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
749 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100750 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200751 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
752 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200753
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100754ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
755 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
756 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300757 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100758 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
759 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
760 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
761 "bind" keyword for more information.
762
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100763ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
764 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
765 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
766 keyword to see available options.
767
768 Example:
769 global
770 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
771
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100772ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
774 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300775 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100776 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
777 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
778 information.
779
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100780ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
782 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
783 keyword to see available options.
784
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200785ssl-dh-param-file <file>
786 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
787 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
788 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
789 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
790 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
791 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them directly
792 in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size specified
793 by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are known to be
794 more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
795 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
796 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
797 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
798
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100799ssl-server-verify [none|required]
800 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
801 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
802 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
803
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200804stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
805 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
806 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
807 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
808 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200809
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200810 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
811 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
812 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200813
814stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
815 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
816 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100817 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200818
819stats maxconn <connections>
820 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
821 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823uid <number>
824 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
825 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
826 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
827 one. See also "gid" and "user".
828
829ulimit-n <number>
830 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
831 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
832 option.
833
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100834unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
835 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
836
837 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
838 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
839 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
840 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
841 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
842 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
843 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
844 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
845 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
846 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
847
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200848user <user name>
849 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
850 See also "uid" and "group".
851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200852node <name>
853 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
854
855 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
856 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
857 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
858 traffic.
859
860description <text>
861 Add a text that describes the instance.
862
863 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
864 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
865 "<" and ">" characters.
866
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010086751degrees-data-file <file path>
868 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
869 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
870
871 Please note that this options is only available when haproxy has been
872 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
873
87451degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
875 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
876 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
877 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
878
879 Please note that this options is only available when haproxy has been
880 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
881
88251degrees-property-seperator <char>
883 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
884 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
885
886 Please note that this options is only available when haproxy has been
887 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
888
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008903.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200891-----------------------
892
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200893max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
894 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
895 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
896 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
897 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
898 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
899 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
900 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
901 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
902
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200903maxconn <number>
904 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
905 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
906 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200907 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
908 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
909 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
910 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100911 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
912 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
913 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
914 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
915 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200916
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200917maxconnrate <number>
918 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
919 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
920 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
921 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
922 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
923 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
924 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
925 fairness.
926
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100927maxcomprate <number>
928 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300929 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100930 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
931 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
932 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
933 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
934 default value.
935
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100936maxcompcpuusage <number>
937 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
938 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
939 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
940 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
941 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
942 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
943 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
944 process down and from introducing high latencies.
945
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100946maxpipes <number>
947 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
948 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
949 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
950 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
951 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
952 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
953
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200954maxsessrate <number>
955 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
956 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
957 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
958 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
959 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
960 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
961 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
962 fairness.
963
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200964maxsslconn <number>
965 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
966 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
967 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
968 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
969 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
970 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
971 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100972 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
973 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
974 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
975 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
976 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
977 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
978 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200979
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200980maxsslrate <number>
981 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
982 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
983 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
984 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
985 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
986 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
987 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
988 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
989 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
990 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
991
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100992maxzlibmem <number>
993 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
994 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
995 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100996 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
997 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
998 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
999
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001000noepoll
1001 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1002 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001003 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001004
1005nokqueue
1006 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1007 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1008 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1009
1010nopoll
1011 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1012 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001013 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001014 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001015
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001016nosplice
1017 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1018 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1019 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001020 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001021 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1022 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1023 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1024 "option splice-response".
1025
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001026nogetaddrinfo
1027 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1028 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1029
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001030spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001031 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1032 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1033 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1034 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1035 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1036 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001037
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001038tune.buffers.limit <number>
1039 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1040 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1041 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1042 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1043 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1044 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1045 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1046 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1047 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1048 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1049 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1050 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1051 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1052 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1053 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1054
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001055tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1056 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1057 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1058 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1059 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1060
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001061tune.bufsize <number>
1062 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1063 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1064 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1065 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1066 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1067 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1068 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1069 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001070 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1071 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1072 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001073
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001074tune.chksize <number>
1075 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1076 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1077 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1078 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1079 checks whenever possible.
1080
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001081tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1082 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1083 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1084 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1085 this value. The default value is 1.
1086
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001087tune.http.cookielen <number>
1088 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1089 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1090 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1091 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1092 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1093 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1094 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1095 to change this value.
1096
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001097tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1098 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1099 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1100 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1101 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1102 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1103 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1104 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1105 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1106 limit too high.
1107
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001108tune.idletimer <timeout>
1109 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1110 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1111 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1112 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1113 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1114 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1115 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1116 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1117 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1118
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001119tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1120 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1121 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1122 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1123 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1124 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1125 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1126 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1127
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001128tune.lua.maxmem
1129 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1130 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1131 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1132 memory.
1133
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001134tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1135 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1136 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1137 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1138 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1139 4s.
1140
1141tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1142 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1143 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1144 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1145 check servers.
1146
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001147tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001148 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1149 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1150 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1151 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1152 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1153 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1154 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1155 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1156 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1157 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001158
1159tune.maxpollevents <number>
1160 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1161 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1162 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1163 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1164 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1165
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001166tune.maxrewrite <number>
1167 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1168 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1169 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1170 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1171 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1172 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1173 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1174 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1175 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1176 bufsize.
1177
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001178tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1179 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1180 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1181 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1182 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1183 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1184 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1185 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1186 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1187 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1188 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1189 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1190 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1191 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1192 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1193 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1194 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1195 setting this parameter to 0.
1196
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001197tune.pipesize <number>
1198 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1199 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1200 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1201 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1202 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1203 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1204
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001205tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1206tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1207 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1208 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1209 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1210 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1211 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1212 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1213 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1214
1215tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1216tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1217 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1218 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1219 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1220 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1221 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1222 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1223 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1224 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1225 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1226 notifying haproxy again.
1227
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001228tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001229 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1230 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1231 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001232 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001233 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1234 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1235 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1236 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1237 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001238 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1239 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001240
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001241tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1242 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1243 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1244 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1245 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1246 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1247 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1248
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001249tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1250 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001251 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001252 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1253 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1254 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1255 being used for too long.
1256
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001257tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1258 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1259 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1260 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1261 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1262 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1263 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1264 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1265 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1266 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1267 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001268 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1269 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001270
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001271tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1272 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1273 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1274 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1275 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1276 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1277 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1278 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001279 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1280 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001281
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001282tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1283 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1284 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1285 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1286 1000 entries.
1287
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001288tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1289 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001290 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001291 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1292 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1293 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1294
1295tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1296 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1297 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1298 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1299 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013013.3. Debugging
1302--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001303
1304debug
1305 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1306 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1307 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1308 system startup.
1309
1310quiet
1311 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1312 line argument "-q".
1313
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013153.4. Userlists
1316--------------
1317It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1318http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1319it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1320
1321userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001322 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001323 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1324
1325group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001326 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001327 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1328 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1329
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001330user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1331 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001332 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1333 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001334 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1335 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001336 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001337 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001338
1339
1340 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001341 userlist L1
1342 group G1 users tiger,scott
1343 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001344
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001345 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1346 user scott insecure-password elgato
1347 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001348
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001349 userlist L2
1350 group G1
1351 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001352
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001353 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1354 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1355 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001356
1357 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001358
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001359
13603.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001361----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001362It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1363haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1364pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1365identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1366or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1367Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1368known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1369the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1370process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1371during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1372tables.
1373
1374peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001375 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001376 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1377
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001378disabled
1379 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1380 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1381 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1382
1383enable
1384 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1385
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001386peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1387 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1388 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1389 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1390 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1391 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1392 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1393
1394 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1395 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1396
1397 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1398 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1399 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1400 across all peers.
1401
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001402 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1403 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001404
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001405 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001406 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001407 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1408 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1409 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001410
1411 backend mybackend
1412 mode tcp
1413 balance roundrobin
1414 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1415 stick on src
1416
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001417 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1418 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001419
1420
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090014213.6. Mailers
1422------------
1423It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1424If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1425in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1426
1427mailer <mailersect>
1428 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1429 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1430
1431mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1432 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1433
1434 Example:
1435 mailers mymailers
1436 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1437 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1438
1439 backend mybackend
1440 mode tcp
1441 balance roundrobin
1442
1443 email-alert mailers mymailers
1444 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1445 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1446
1447 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1448 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1449
1450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014514. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001452----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001453
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001454Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001455 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001456 - frontend <name>
1457 - backend <name>
1458 - listen <name>
1459
1460A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1461its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1462section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001463section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001464
1465A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1466connections.
1467
1468A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1469to forward incoming connections.
1470
1471A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1472parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1473
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001474All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1475'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1476case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1477
1478Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1479logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1480proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1481However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1482name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1483
1484Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1485and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001486bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1488modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1489arbitrary criteria.
1490
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001491In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1492a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1493the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1494
1495 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1496 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1497 between responses and new requests.
1498
1499 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1500 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1501 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1502 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1503
1504 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1505 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1506 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1507
1508 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1509 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1510 client-facing connection remains open.
1511
1512 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1513 after the end of the response.
1514
1515The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1516frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1517following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1518weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1519
1520 Backend mode
1521
1522 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1523 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1524 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1525 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1526 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1527 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1528 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1529 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1530 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1531 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1532 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1533
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001534
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015364.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1537--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001539The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1540limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1541they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1542limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001543marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001544option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001545and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1546with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1547specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001548
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001549
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001550 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1551------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1552acl - X X X
1553appsession - - X X
1554backlog X X X -
1555balance X - X X
1556bind - X X -
1557bind-process X X X X
1558block - X X X
1559capture cookie - X X -
1560capture request header - X X -
1561capture response header - X X -
1562clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001563compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001564contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1565cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001566declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001567default-server X - X X
1568default_backend X X X -
1569description - X X X
1570disabled X X X X
1571dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001572email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001573email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001574email-alert mailers X X X X
1575email-alert myhostname X X X X
1576email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001577enabled X X X X
1578errorfile X X X X
1579errorloc X X X X
1580errorloc302 X X X X
1581-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1582errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001583force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001584fullconn X - X X
1585grace X X X X
1586hash-type X - X X
1587http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001588http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001589http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001590http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001591http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001592http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001593id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001594ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001595log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001596log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001597log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001598max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001599maxconn X X X -
1600mode X X X X
1601monitor fail - X X -
1602monitor-net X X X -
1603monitor-uri X X X -
1604option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1605option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1606option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1607option allbackups (*) X - X X
1608option checkcache (*) X - X X
1609option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1610option contstats (*) X X X -
1611option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1612option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1613option forceclose (*) X X X X
1614-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1615option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001616option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001617option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001618option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001619option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001620option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001621option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001622option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001623option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1624option httpchk X - X X
1625option httpclose (*) X X X X
1626option httplog X X X X
1627option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001628option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001629option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001630option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001631option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1632option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1633option logasap (*) X X X -
1634option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001635option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001636option nolinger (*) X X X X
1637option originalto X X X X
1638option persist (*) X - X X
1639option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001640option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001641option smtpchk X - X X
1642option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1643option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1644option splice-request (*) X X X X
1645option splice-response (*) X X X X
1646option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1647option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1648-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001649option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001650option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1651option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1652option tcpka X X X X
1653option tcplog X X X X
1654option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001655external-check command X - X X
1656external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001657persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1658rate-limit sessions X X X -
1659redirect - X X X
1660redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1661redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1662reqadd - X X X
1663reqallow - X X X
1664reqdel - X X X
1665reqdeny - X X X
1666reqiallow - X X X
1667reqidel - X X X
1668reqideny - X X X
1669reqipass - X X X
1670reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001671reqitarpit - X X X
1672reqpass - X X X
1673reqrep - X X X
1674-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001675reqtarpit - X X X
1676retries X - X X
1677rspadd - X X X
1678rspdel - X X X
1679rspdeny - X X X
1680rspidel - X X X
1681rspideny - X X X
1682rspirep - X X X
1683rsprep - X X X
1684server - - X X
1685source X - X X
1686srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001687stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001688stats auth X - X X
1689stats enable X - X X
1690stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001691stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001692stats realm X - X X
1693stats refresh X - X X
1694stats scope X - X X
1695stats show-desc X - X X
1696stats show-legends X - X X
1697stats show-node X - X X
1698stats uri X - X X
1699-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1700stick match - - X X
1701stick on - - X X
1702stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001703stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001704stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001705tcp-check connect - - X X
1706tcp-check expect - - X X
1707tcp-check send - - X X
1708tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001709tcp-request connection - X X -
1710tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001711tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001712tcp-response content - - X X
1713tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001714timeout check X - X X
1715timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001716timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001717timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1718timeout connect X - X X
1719timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1720timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1721timeout http-request X X X X
1722timeout queue X - X X
1723timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001724timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001725timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1726timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001727timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001728transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001729unique-id-format X X X -
1730unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001731use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001732use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001733------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1734 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001735
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017374.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1738---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001739
1740This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1741
1742
1743acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1744 Declare or complete an access list.
1745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1746 no | yes | yes | yes
1747 Example:
1748 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1749 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1750 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001752 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001753
1754
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001755appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1756 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001757 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1759 no | no | yes | yes
1760 Arguments :
1761 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1762 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1763
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001764 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001765 checked in each cookie value.
1766
1767 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1768 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1769 milliseconds.
1770
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001771 request-learn
1772 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1773 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1774 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1775 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1776 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1777 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1778
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001779 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1780 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1781 data following this prefix.
1782
1783 Example :
1784 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1785
1786 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1787 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1788
1789 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1790 2 modes are currently supported :
1791 - path-parameters :
1792 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1793 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1794 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1795 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1796 - query-string :
1797 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1798 query string.
1799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001800 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1801 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1802 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1803 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001804 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1805 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1806 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1808 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1809
1810 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1811
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001812 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1813 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1814 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001816 Example :
1817 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1818
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001819 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1820 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821
1822
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001823backlog <conns>
1824 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1826 yes | yes | yes | no
1827 Arguments :
1828 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1829 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001830 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001831
1832 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1833 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1834 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1835 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1836 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1837 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1838 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1839 backlog parameter.
1840
1841 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1842 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1843 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1844
1845 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1846
1847
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001849balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001850 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1852 yes | no | yes | yes
1853 Arguments :
1854 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1855 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1856 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1857 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1858
1859 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1860 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1861 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1862 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001863 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001864 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001865 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1866 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1867 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1868 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1869 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1870 it, so that you don't worry.
1871
1872 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1873 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1874 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1875 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1876 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1877 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1878 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1879 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001880
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001881 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1882 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1883 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1884 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1885 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1886 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1887 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1888 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1889
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001890 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001891 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001892 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1893 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001894 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001895 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1896 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1897 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1898 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1899 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001900 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1901 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1902 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1903 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1904 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1905 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001906
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001907 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1908 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1909 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1910 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1911 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1912 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1913 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1914 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001915 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001916 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001917 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1918 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1919 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001920
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001921 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1922 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1923 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1924 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1925 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1926 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1927 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1928 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1929 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1930 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1931 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1932 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001933
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001934 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001935 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1936 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1937 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1938 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1939 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1940 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1941 URIs start with a leading "/".
1942
1943 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1944 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1945 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1946 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1947
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001948 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001949 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1950
1951 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001952 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1953 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001954 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1955 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1956 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1957 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001958 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001959 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1960 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001961
1962 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1963 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1964 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1965 server will receive the request.
1966
1967 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1968 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1969 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1970 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1971 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001972 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1973 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1974 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001975
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001976 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1977 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1978 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1979 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1980 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001982 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001983 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1984 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1985 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1986
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001987 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1988 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1989 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1990
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001991 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001992 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001993 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1994 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1995 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1996 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1997 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1998 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001999 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002000 used instead.
2001
2002 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2003 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2004 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2005 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2006
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002007 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2008 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2009 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2010
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002011 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002012
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002013 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002014 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2015 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002016
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002017 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2018 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2019 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020
2021 Examples :
2022 balance roundrobin
2023 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002024 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002025 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2026 balance hdr(host)
2027 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002028
2029 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2030 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2031
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002032 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002033 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2034 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2035 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2036 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2037
2038 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2039 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2040 defaults to 16 kB.
2041
2042 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2043 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2044
2045 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2046 Round Robin.
2047
2048 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2049 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2050 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2051 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2052
2053 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2054
2055 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002056 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002057 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2058 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2059 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002061 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
2062 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002063
2064
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002065bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2066bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002067 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2069 no | yes | yes | no
2070 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002071 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2072 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2073 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2074 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002075 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002076 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2077 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2078 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2079 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2080 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2081 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2082 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002083 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2084 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2085 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2086 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2087 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2088 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2089 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002090 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2091 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2092 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002093 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2094 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2095 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002096
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002097 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2098 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002099 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2100 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2101 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002102 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2103 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2104 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2105 the range.
2106
2107 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2108 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2109 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2110 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2111 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2112 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2113 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002114 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002115 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002117 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2118 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2119 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2120 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2121 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2122 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2123 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2124 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2125
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002126 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2127 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2128 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2129 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002130
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002131 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2132 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2133 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2134 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2135 in a frontend.
2136
2137 Example :
2138 listen http_proxy
2139 bind :80,:443
2140 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002141 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002142
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002143 listen http_https_proxy
2144 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002145 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002146
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002147 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2148 bind ipv6@:80
2149 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2150 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2151
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002152 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002153 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002154
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002155 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002156 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157
2158
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002159bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002160 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2162 yes | yes | yes | yes
2163 Arguments :
2164 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2165 may be used to override a default value.
2166
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002167 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002168 option may be combined with other numbers.
2169
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002170 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002171 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2172 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2173 missing from all processes.
2174
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002175 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002176 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002177 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2178 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2179 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2180 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002181
2182 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2183 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2184 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2185 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2186 and 'even' instances.
2187
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002188 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2189 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2190 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2191 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002192
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002193 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2194 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2195
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002196 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2197 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2198 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2199
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002200 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2201 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2202
2203 Example :
2204 listen app_ip1
2205 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002206 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002207
2208 listen app_ip2
2209 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002210 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002211
2212 listen management
2213 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002214 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002215
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002216 listen management
2217 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2218 bind-process 1-4
2219
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002220 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002221
2222
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002223block { if | unless } <condition>
2224 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2226 no | yes | yes | yes
2227
2228 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2229 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002230 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002231 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002232 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2233 "block" statements per instance.
2234
2235 Example:
2236 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2237 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2238 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2239 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002241 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242
2243
2244capture cookie <name> len <length>
2245 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2247 no | yes | yes | no
2248 Arguments :
2249 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2250 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2251 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2252 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2253 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2254
2255 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2256 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2257 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2258 right if it exceeds <length>.
2259
2260 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2261 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2262 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2263 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2264
2265 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2266 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2267 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2268
2269 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2270 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2271 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002272 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2273 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2274 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002275
2276 Example:
2277 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2278
2279 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002280 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002281
2282
2283capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002284 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2286 no | yes | yes | no
2287 Arguments :
2288 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002289 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002290 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2291 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2292 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2293
2294 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2295 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2296 it exceeds <length>.
2297
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002298 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2300 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002301 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2302 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2303 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2304 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002305 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002306 environments to find where the request came from.
2307
2308 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2309 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2310 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2311 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002312
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002313 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2314 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2315 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2316 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2317 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002318
2319 Example:
2320 capture request header Host len 15
2321 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2322 capture request header Referrer len 15
2323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002324 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002325 about logging.
2326
2327
2328capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002329 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2331 no | yes | yes | no
2332 Arguments :
2333 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002334 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002335 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2336 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2337 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2338
2339 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2340 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2341 it exceeds <length>.
2342
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002343 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002344 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2345 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2346 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002347 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2348 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2349 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2350 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002351
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002352 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2353 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2354 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2355 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2356 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002357
2358 Example:
2359 capture response header Content-length len 9
2360 capture response header Location len 15
2361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002362 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363 about logging.
2364
2365
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002366clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002367 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2369 yes | yes | yes | no
2370 Arguments :
2371 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2372 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2373 as explained at the top of this document.
2374
2375 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2376 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2377 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2378 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2379 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2380 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2381 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2382 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002383 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002384 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2385 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2386
2387 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2388 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2389 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2390 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2391 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2392 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2393
2394 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2395 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2396
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002397 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2398 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002400compression algo <algorithm> ...
2401compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002402compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002403 Enable HTTP compression.
2404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2405 yes | yes | yes | yes
2406 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002407 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2408 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2409 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2410
2411 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002412 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2413 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2414 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002415
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002416 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2417 support for zlib was built in.
2418
2419 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2420 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2421 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2422 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2423 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2424 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002425
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002426 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2427 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2428 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2429 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2430 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2431 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2432 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2433 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002434
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002435 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002436 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002437 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2438 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2439 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2440 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2441 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002442
2443 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2444 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2445 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2446 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2447 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002448 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2449 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2450 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2451 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2452 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002453 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2454 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002455
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002456 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002457 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2458 "Accept-Encoding" header
2459 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002460 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002461 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2462 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002463 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2464 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2465 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2466 "multipart"
2467 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2468 header
2469 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2470 and later
2471 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2472 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002473
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002474 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2475 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002476
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002477 Examples :
2478 compression algo gzip
2479 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002481contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002482 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2484 yes | no | yes | yes
2485 Arguments :
2486 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2487 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2488 as explained at the top of this document.
2489
2490 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002491 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002492 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002493 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2494 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2495 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2496 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2497
2498 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2499 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2500 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2501 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2502 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2503 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2504
2505 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2506 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2507 instead.
2508
2509 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2510 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2511
2512
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002513cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002514 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2515 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2518 yes | no | yes | yes
2519 Arguments :
2520 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2521 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2522 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2523 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2524 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2525 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2526 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2527 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2528 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2529
2530 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2531 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2532 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2533 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2534 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2535 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2536 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2537 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2538 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2539 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2540 "insert" and "prefix".
2541
2542 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002543 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002544
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002545 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002546 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2547 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2548 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2549 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2550 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2551 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2552 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2553 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2554 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2555 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556
2557 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2558 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2559 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2560 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2561 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2562 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2563 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2564 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2565 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2566 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002567 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2568 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2569 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002571 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2572 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2573 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002574 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2575 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2576 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2577 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002578 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2579 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2580 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002581
2582 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2583 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2584 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2585 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2586 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2587 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2588 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2589 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2590 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2591
2592 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2593 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2594 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2595 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2596 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2597 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2598 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2599 persistence cookie in the cache.
2600 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2601
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002602 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2603 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2604 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2605 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2606 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2607 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2608 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2609 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2610 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2611 they logout.
2612
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002613 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2614 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2615 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2616 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2617
2618 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2619 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2620 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2621 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2622 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2623 this attribute.
2624
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002625 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002626 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002627 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2628 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2629 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2630 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2631 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2632 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002633
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002634 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2635 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2636 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2637 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2638 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2639 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2640 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2641 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2642 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2643 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2644 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2645 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2646 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2647 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2648 the site.
2649
2650 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2651 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2652 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2653 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2654 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2655 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2656 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2657 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2658 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2659 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2660 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2661 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2662 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2663 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2664 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2665 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2666
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2668 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2669 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2670 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002671
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002672 Examples :
2673 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2674 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2675 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002676 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002677
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002678 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002679 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002681
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002682declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2683 Declares a capture slot.
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2685 no | yes | yes | no
2686 Arguments:
2687 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2688
2689 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2690 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2691 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2692 for use in the response.
2693
2694 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2695 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2696
2697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002698default-server [param*]
2699 Change default options for a server in a backend
2700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2701 yes | no | yes | yes
2702 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002703 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2704 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2705 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2706 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002707
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002708 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002709 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2710
2711 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002713
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002714default_backend <backend>
2715 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2717 yes | yes | yes | no
2718 Arguments :
2719 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2720
2721 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2722 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2723 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2724 will catch all undetermined requests.
2725
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002726 Example :
2727
2728 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2729 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2730 default_backend dynamic
2731
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002732 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002735description <string>
2736 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2738 no | yes | yes | yes
2739 Arguments : string
2740
2741 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2742 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2743 it describes.
2744 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2745
2746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002747disabled
2748 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2750 yes | yes | yes | yes
2751 Arguments : none
2752
2753 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2754 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2755 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2756 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2757 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2758 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2759 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2760
2761 See also : "enabled"
2762
2763
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002764dispatch <address>:<port>
2765 Set a default server address
2766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2767 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002768 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002769
2770 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2771 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2772 during start-up.
2773
2774 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2775 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2776 possible with normal servers.
2777
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002778 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002779 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2780 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2781 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2782 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2783
2784 See also : "server"
2785
2786
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002787enabled
2788 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2790 yes | yes | yes | yes
2791 Arguments : none
2792
2793 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2794 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2795
2796 See also : "disabled"
2797
2798
2799errorfile <code> <file>
2800 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2802 yes | yes | yes | yes
2803 Arguments :
2804 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002805 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2806 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002807
2808 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002809 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002810 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002811 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2812 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813
2814 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2815 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2816 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2817
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002818 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2819
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002820 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2821 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2822 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2823 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2824
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002825 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2826 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2827 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2828 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2829 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2830 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2833 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2834 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002835 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002836 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2837
2838 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2839
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002840 Example :
2841 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002842 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002843 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2844 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2845
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002846
2847errorloc <code> <url>
2848errorloc302 <code> <url>
2849 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2851 yes | yes | yes | yes
2852 Arguments :
2853 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002854 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002855
2856 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2857 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2858 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2859 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2860 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2861
2862 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2863 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2864 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2865
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002866 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2867
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002868 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2869 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2870 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2871 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2872 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2873 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2874 request.
2875
2876 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2877
2878
2879errorloc303 <code> <url>
2880 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2882 yes | yes | yes | yes
2883 Arguments :
2884 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2885 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2886
2887 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2888 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2889 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2890 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2891 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2892
2893 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2894 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2895 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2896
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002897 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2898
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002899 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2900 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2901 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2902 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002903 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002904
2905 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2906
2907
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002908email-alert from <emailaddr>
2909 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2910 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2911 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2912 yes | yes | yes | yes
2913
2914 Arguments :
2915
2916 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2917
2918 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2919 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2920
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002921 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2922 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2923
2924
2925email-alert level <level>
2926 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2927 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2928 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2929 yes | yes | yes | yes
2930
2931 Arguments :
2932
2933 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2934 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2935 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2936
2937 By default level is alert
2938
2939 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2940 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2941 for the proxy.
2942
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002943 Alerts are sent when :
2944
2945 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2946 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2947 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2948 is notice or lower
2949 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2950 and a health check status update occurs
2951
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002952 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2953 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002954 section 3.6 about mailers.
2955
2956
2957email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2958 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2959 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2960 yes | yes | yes | yes
2961
2962 Arguments :
2963
2964 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2965
2966 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2967 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2968
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002969 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2970 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002971
2972
2973email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2974 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2975 mailers.
2976 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2977 yes | yes | yes | yes
2978
2979 Arguments :
2980
2981 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2982
2983 By default the systems hostname is used.
2984
2985 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2986 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2987 for the proxy.
2988
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002989 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2990 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002991
2992
2993email-alert to <emailaddr>
2994 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2995 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2997 yes | yes | yes | yes
2998
2999 Arguments :
3000
3001 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3002
3003 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3004 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3005
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003006 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003007 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3008
3009
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003010force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3011 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3012 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3013 no | yes | yes | yes
3014
3015 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3016 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3017 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3018 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3019 marked down for maintenance operations.
3020
3021 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3022 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3023 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3024 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3025 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3026 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3027 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3028 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3029 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3030
3031 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3032 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3033 is used.
3034
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003035 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003036 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003037
3038
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003039fullconn <conns>
3040 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3042 yes | no | yes | yes
3043 Arguments :
3044 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3045 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3046
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003047 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003048 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003049 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003050 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3051 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3052 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3053 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3054 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003055 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003056
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003057 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3058 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003059 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3060 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3061 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003062
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003063 Example :
3064 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3065 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3066 # connections.
3067 backend dynamic
3068 fullconn 10000
3069 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3070 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3071
3072 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3073
3074
3075grace <time>
3076 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003078 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003079 Arguments :
3080 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3081 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3082 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3083
3084 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3085 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003086 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003087 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3088
3089 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3090 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3091 simplify it.
3092
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003093
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003094hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003095 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3097 yes | no | yes | yes
3098 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003099 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3100 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003101
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003102 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3103 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3104 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3105 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3106 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3107 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3108 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3109 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3110 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3111 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003112
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003113 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3114 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3115 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3116 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3117 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3118 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3119 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3120 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3121 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3122 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3123 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3124 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3125 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003126 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3127 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003128
3129 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3130
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003131 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003132 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3133 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3134 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003135 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3136 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3137 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003138
3139 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3140 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003141 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3142 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3143 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3144 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3145
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003146 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3147 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3148 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3149 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3150 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3151 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3152 parameter.
3153
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003154 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3155 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3156 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3157 used on strings.
3158
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003159 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3160
3161 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3162 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3163 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3164 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3165 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3166 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3167 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3168 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3169 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3170 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3171 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3172 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003173
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003174 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3175 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3176 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003177
3178 See also : "balance", "server"
3179
3180
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003181http-check disable-on-404
3182 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003184 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003185 Arguments : none
3186
3187 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3188 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3189 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3190 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3191 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3192 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3193 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3194 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003195 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3196 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3197 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3198
3199 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3200
3201
3202http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003203 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003205 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003206 Arguments :
3207 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3208 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003209 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003210 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3211 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3212 details on the supported keywords.
3213
3214 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3215 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3216 with the usual backslash ('\').
3217
3218 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3219 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3220 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3221 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3222 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3223
3224 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003225 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003226 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3227 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3228 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3229
3230 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003231 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003232 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3233 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3234 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3235 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3236
3237 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003238 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003239 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3240 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3241 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3242 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3243 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3244 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3245 trace).
3246
3247 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003248 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003249 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3250 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3251 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3252 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3253 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3254 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3255
3256 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3257 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3258 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3259 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3260 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3261 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3262 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3263 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3264
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003265 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3266 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3267 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3268
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003269 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3270 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3271
3272 Examples :
3273 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003274 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003275
3276 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003277 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003278
3279 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003280 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003281
3282 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003283 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003284
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003285 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003286
3287
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003288http-check send-state
3289 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3291 yes | no | yes | yes
3292 Arguments : none
3293
3294 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3295 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3296 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3297 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3298 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3299
3300 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3301 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3302 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3303 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3304 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003305 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3306 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3307 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3308
3309 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3310 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3311 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3312
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003313 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3314 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3315 checked in multiple backends.
3316
3317 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3318 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3319
3320 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3321 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3322 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3323 one fails.
3324
3325 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3326 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3327 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3328
3329 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3330 server's queue.
3331
3332 Example of a header received by the application server :
3333 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3334 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3335
3336 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3337
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003338http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003339 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003340 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003341 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003342 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3343 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003344 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3345 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003346 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3347 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3348 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003349 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003350 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3351 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003352 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003353 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003354 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3355
3356 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 no | yes | yes | yes
3358
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003359 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3360 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3361 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3362 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3363 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003364
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003365 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3366 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3367 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3368
3369 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3370 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3371 are evaluated.
3372
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003373 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3374 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3375 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3376 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3377 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3378 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3379 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3380 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3381 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003382 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003383 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3384
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003385 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3386 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3387 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3388 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3389 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3390
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003391 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3392 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3393 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003394 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3395 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003396
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003397 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3398 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3399 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3400 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3401 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3402 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3403 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3404 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3405
3406 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3407 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3408 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003409 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3410 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003411
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003412 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3413 <name>.
3414
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003415 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3416 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3417 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3418 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3419 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3420 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3421 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3422 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3423
3424 Example:
3425
3426 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3427
3428 applied to:
3429
3430 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3431
3432 outputs:
3433
3434 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3435
3436 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3437
3438 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3439 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3440 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3441 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3442 header.
3443
3444 Example:
3445
3446 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3447
3448 applied to:
3449
3450 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3451
3452 outputs:
3453
3454 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3455
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003456 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3457 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3458 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3459 it.
3460
3461 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3462 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3463 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3464 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3465 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3466 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3467
3468 Example :
3469 # prepend the host name before the path
3470 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3471
3472 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3473 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3474 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3475 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3476 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3477 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3478 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3479 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3480
3481 Example :
3482 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3483 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3484
3485 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3486 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3487 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3488 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3489 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3490 "set-query".
3491
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003492 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3493 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3494 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3495 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3496 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3497 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3498 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3499 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3500
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003501 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3502 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3503 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3504 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3505 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3506 another equipment.
3507
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003508 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3509 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3510 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3511 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3512 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3513 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3514 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3515 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3516
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003517 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3518 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3519 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3520 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3521 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3522 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3523 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3524 admin privileges.
3525
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003526 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3527 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3528 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3529 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3530 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3531 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3532 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3533 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3534
3535 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3536 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3537 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3538 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3539 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3540 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3541
3542 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3543 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3544 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3545 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3546 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3547 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3548
3549 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3550 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3551 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3552 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3553 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3554 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3555 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3556 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3557 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3558
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003559 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003560 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3561 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3562 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3563 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3564 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3565 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3566 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3567 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3568 request header" for more information.
3569
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003570 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3571 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3572 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3573 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3574
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003575 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3576 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3577 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3578 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3579 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3580 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3581 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3582 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3583 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3584 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3585 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3586 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3587
3588 These actions take one or two arguments :
3589 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3590 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3591 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3592 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3593
3594 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3595 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3596 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3597 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3598
3599 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3600 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3601 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3602 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3603 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3604 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3605 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3606 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3607
3608 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3609 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3610 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3611 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3612 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3613
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003614 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3615 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3616 function is documented in the API documentation.
3617
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003618 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3619
3620 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3621 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3622 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3623 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003624
3625 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003626 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3627 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3628 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003629
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003630 http-request allow if nagios
3631 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3632 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3633 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003634
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003635 Example:
3636 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003637 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003638
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003639 Example:
3640 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3641 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3642 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3643 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3644 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3645 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3646 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3647 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3648 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3649
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003650 Example:
3651 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3652 acl add path /addacl
3653 acl del path /delacl
3654
3655 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3656
3657 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3658 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3659
3660 Example:
3661 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3662 acl setmap path /setmap
3663 acl delmap path /delmap
3664
3665 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3666
3667 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3668 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3669
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003670 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3671 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003672
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003673http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003674 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003675 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003676 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3677 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003678 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3679 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3680 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3681 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003682 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3683 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003684 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003685 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003686 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3687
3688 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3689 no | yes | yes | yes
3690
3691 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3692 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3693 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3694 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3695 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3696 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3697
3698 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3699 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3700 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3701 current section.
3702
3703 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3704 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3705 rules are evaluated.
3706
3707 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3708 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3709 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3710 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3711 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3712 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3713 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3714
3715 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3716 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3717 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3718 external users.
3719
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003720 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3721 <name>.
3722
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003723 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3724 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3725 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3726 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3727 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3728 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3729 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3730 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3731
3732 Example:
3733
3734 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3735
3736 applied to:
3737
3738 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3739
3740 outputs:
3741
3742 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3743
3744 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3745
3746 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3747 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3748 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3749 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3750 header.
3751
3752 Example:
3753
3754 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3755
3756 applied to:
3757
3758 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3759
3760 outputs:
3761
3762 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3763
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003764 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3765 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3766 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3767 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3768 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3769 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3770 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3771 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3772
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003773 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3774 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3775 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3776 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3777 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3778 another equipment.
3779
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003780 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3781 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3782 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3783 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3784 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3785 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3786 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3787 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3788
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003789 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3790 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3791 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3792 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3793 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3794 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3795 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3796 admin privileges.
3797
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003798 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3799 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3800 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3801 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3802 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3803 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3804 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3805 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3806
3807 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3808 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3809 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3810 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3811 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3812 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3813
3814 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3815 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3816 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3817 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3818 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3819 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3820
3821 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3822 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3823 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3824 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3825 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3826 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3827 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3828 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3829 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3830
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003831 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3832 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3833 function is documented in the API documentation.
3834
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003835 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3836 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3837 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3838 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3839 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3840 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
3841 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3842 response header" for more information.
3843
3844 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
3845 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
3846 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
3847 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
3848 keyword.
3849
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003850 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3851 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
3852 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
3853 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
3854 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
3855 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
3856
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003857 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3858
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003859 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003860 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3861 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3862 rules.
3863
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003864 Example:
3865 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3866
3867 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3868
3869 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3870 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3871
3872 Example:
3873 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3874
3875 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3876
3877 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3878 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3879
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003880 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3881 ACL usage.
3882
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003883
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003884http-send-name-header [<header>]
3885 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3886
3887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3888 yes | no | yes | yes
3889
3890 Arguments :
3891
3892 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3893
3894 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3895 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3896 is added with the header string proved.
3897
3898 See also : "server"
3899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003900id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003901 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3903 no | yes | yes | yes
3904 Arguments : none
3905
3906 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3907 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3908 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003909
3910
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003911ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3912 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3913 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3914 no | yes | yes | yes
3915
3916 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3917 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3918 and running).
3919
3920 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3921 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3922 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003923 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003924 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3925
3926 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3927 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3928
3929 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3930 "unless" condition is met.
3931
3932 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3933
3934
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003935log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003936log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003937no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003938 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3940 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003941
3942 Prefix :
3943 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3944 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3945 prefix does not allow arguments.
3946
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003947 Arguments :
3948 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3949 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3950 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3951 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3952 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3953 parameter.
3954
3955 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3956 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3957
3958 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3959 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3960 standard syslog port).
3961
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003962 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3963 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3964 standard syslog port).
3965
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003966 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3967 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3968 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3969 appropriately writeable).
3970
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003971 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3972 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003973
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003974 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3975 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3976 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3977 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3978 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3979 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3980 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3981 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3982 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3983 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3984 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3985
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003986 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3987
3988 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3989 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3990 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3991
3992 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3993 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3994 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003995 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3996 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3997 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3998 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3999 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004000
4001 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4002
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004003 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4004 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4005 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004006
4007 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4008 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4009 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4010 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4011
4012 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4013 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004014
4015 Example :
4016 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004017 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4018 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004019 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004020
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004021
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004022log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004023 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004026
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004027 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4028 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4029 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4030 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4031 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004032
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004033log-tag <string>
4034 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4035 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4036 yes | yes | yes | yes
4037
4038 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4039 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4040 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4041 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4042 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4043 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4044 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4045 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4046 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004047
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004048max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4049 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4050 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4051 yes | no | yes | yes
4052
4053 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4054 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4055 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4056 servers.
4057
4058 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4059 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4060 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4061 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4062 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4063 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4064 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4065 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4066 picking a different server.
4067
4068 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4069 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4070 even if they have to be queued.
4071
4072 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4073 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4074
4075
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004076maxconn <conns>
4077 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 yes | yes | yes | no
4080 Arguments :
4081 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4082 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4083 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4084 closes.
4085
4086 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4087 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4088 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4089 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4090 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4091 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4092 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4093 properly tuned.
4094
4095 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4096 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4097 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4098
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004099 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4100
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004101 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4102
4103
4104mode { tcp|http|health }
4105 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4107 yes | yes | yes | yes
4108 Arguments :
4109 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4110 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4111 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4112 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4113
4114 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4115 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4116 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4117 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4118 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4119
4120 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004121 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4122 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4123 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4124 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4125 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4126 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4127 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004128
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004129 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4130 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4131 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004132
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004133 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004134 defaults http_instances
4135 mode http
4136
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004137 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004139
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004140monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004141 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4143 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004144 Arguments :
4145 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4146 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004147 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004148 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4149 backend and its backup.
4150
4151 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4152 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4153 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4154 servers in a list of backends.
4155
4156 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4157 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4158 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4159 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4160 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4161 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4162 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004163 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4164 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004165
4166 Example:
4167 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004168 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004169 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4170 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4171 monitor-uri /site_alive
4172 monitor fail if site_dead
4173
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004174 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004175
4176
4177monitor-net <source>
4178 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4180 yes | yes | yes | no
4181 Arguments :
4182 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4183 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4184 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4185 followed by a mask.
4186
4187 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4188 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004189 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004190 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4191
4192 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4193 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4194 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4195 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004196 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4197 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4198 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004199
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004200 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4201 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4202 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4203 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4204 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4205 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004206
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004207 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4208 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004209
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004210 Example :
4211 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4212 frontend www
4213 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4214
4215 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4216
4217
4218monitor-uri <uri>
4219 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4221 yes | yes | yes | no
4222 Arguments :
4223 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4224 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4225
4226 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4227 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4228 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4229 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4230 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4231 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4232 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4233 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4234
4235 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4236 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4237 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4238 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4239 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4240 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4241
4242 Example :
4243 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4244 frontend www
4245 mode http
4246 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4247
4248 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4249
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004250
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004251option abortonclose
4252no option abortonclose
4253 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4255 yes | no | yes | yes
4256 Arguments : none
4257
4258 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4259 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4260 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4261 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004262 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004263 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4264 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4265 encountered while delivering the response.
4266
4267 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4268 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4269 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4270 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4271 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4272 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004273 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004274 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004275 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004276 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4277 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4278 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4279
4280 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4281 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4282 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4283 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4284 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4285 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4286 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4287 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004288 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004289
4290 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4291 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4292
4293 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4294
4295
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004296option accept-invalid-http-request
4297no option accept-invalid-http-request
4298 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4300 yes | yes | yes | no
4301 Arguments : none
4302
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004303 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004304 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4305 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4306 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4307 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4308 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4309 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4310 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004311 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4312 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4313 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4314 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4315 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004316 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004317 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4318 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4319 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004320
4321 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4322 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4323 been confirmed.
4324
4325 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4326 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004327 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4328 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004329 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4330
4331 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4332 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4333
4334 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4335 stats socket.
4336
4337
4338option accept-invalid-http-response
4339no option accept-invalid-http-response
4340 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4342 yes | no | yes | yes
4343 Arguments : none
4344
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004345 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004346 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4347 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4348 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4349 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4350 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4351 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4352 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004353 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4354 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4355 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004356
4357 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4358 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4359 been confirmed.
4360
4361 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4362 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4363 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4364 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4365
4366 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4367 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4368
4369 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4370 stats socket.
4371
4372
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004373option allbackups
4374no option allbackups
4375 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4377 yes | no | yes | yes
4378 Arguments : none
4379
4380 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4381 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4382 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4383 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4384 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4385 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4386 order between the backup servers anymore.
4387
4388 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4389 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4390
4391 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4392 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4393
4394
4395option checkcache
4396no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004397 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | no | yes | yes
4400 Arguments : none
4401
4402 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4403 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004404 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004405 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4406 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004407 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004408
4409 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004410 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004411 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004412 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4413 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004414 to the client are :
4415 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004416 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004417 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004418 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4419 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4420 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4421 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4422 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4423 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4424 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4425 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4426 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4427 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4428 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4429
4430 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004431 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004432 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004433 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004434 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4435
4436 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4437 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004438 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004439 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4440
4441 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4442 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4443
4444
4445option clitcpka
4446no option clitcpka
4447 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4449 yes | yes | yes | no
4450 Arguments : none
4451
4452 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4453 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4454 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4455 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4456
4457 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4458 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4459 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4460 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4461
4462 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4463 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4464 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4465 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4466 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4467
4468 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4469
4470 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4471 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4472 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4473
4474 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4475 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4476
4477 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4478
4479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004480option contstats
4481 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4483 yes | yes | yes | no
4484 Arguments : none
4485
4486 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4487 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4488 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4489 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4490 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4491 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4492 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4493
4494
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004495option dontlog-normal
4496no option dontlog-normal
4497 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4499 yes | yes | yes | no
4500 Arguments : none
4501
4502 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4503 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4504 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4505 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4506 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4507 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4508 logged.
4509
4510 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4511 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4512 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004514 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004515 logging.
4516
4517
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004518option dontlognull
4519no option dontlognull
4520 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 yes | yes | yes | no
4523 Arguments : none
4524
4525 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4526 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4527 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4528 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4529 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4530 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004531 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4532 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4533 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004534
4535 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4536 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4537 would not be logged.
4538
4539 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4540 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4541
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004542 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4543 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004544
4545
4546option forceclose
4547no option forceclose
4548 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004550 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004551 Arguments : none
4552
4553 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4554 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4555 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4556 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4557 global session times in the logs.
4558
4559 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004560 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004561 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004562
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004563 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4564 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4565 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4566
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004567 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4568 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004569
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004570 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4571 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4572
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004573 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004574
4575
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004576option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004577 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4579 yes | yes | yes | yes
4580 Arguments :
4581 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4582 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004583 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004584 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004585
4586 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4587 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4588 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4589 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4590 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4591 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4592 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004593 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4594 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4595 possible that the client has already brought one.
4596
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004597 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004598 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004599 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4600 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004601 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4602 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004603
4604 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4605 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4606 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4607 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4608 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4609 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4610 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4611
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004612 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4613 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4614 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4615 are under the control of the end-user.
4616
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004617 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004618 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4619 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004620 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4621 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4622 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004623
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004624 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004625 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4626 frontend www
4627 mode http
4628 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4629
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004630 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4631 backend www
4632 mode http
4633 option forwardfor header X-Client
4634
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004635 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004636 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004637
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004638
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004639option http-buffer-request
4640no option http-buffer-request
4641 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4643 yes | yes | yes | yes
4644 Arguments : none
4645
4646 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4647 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4648 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4649 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4650 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4651 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4652 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4653 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4654 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4655 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4656 default.
4657
4658 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4659
4660
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004661option http-ignore-probes
4662no option http-ignore-probes
4663 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4665 yes | yes | yes | no
4666 Arguments : none
4667
4668 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4669 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4670 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4671 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4672 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4673 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4674 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4675 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4676 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4677 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4678 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4679 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4680
4681 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4682 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4683 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4684 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4685 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4686 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4687 are often the only way to detect them.
4688
4689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4691
4692 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4693
4694
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004695option http-keep-alive
4696no option http-keep-alive
4697 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4699 yes | yes | yes | yes
4700 Arguments : none
4701
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004702 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4703 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4704 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4705 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4706 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4707 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4708 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4709
4710 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4711 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004712 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4713 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4714 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4715 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4716 situations where this option may be useful :
4717
4718 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4719 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4720
4721 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4722 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4723
4724 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4725 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4726 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4727 request.
4728
4729 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4730 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004731 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4732 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4733 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004734
4735 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4736 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4737
4738 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4739 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4740 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4741 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4742 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4743 not set.
4744
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004745 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4746 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004747 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004748 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004749
4750 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004751 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4752 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004753
4754
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004755option http-no-delay
4756no option http-no-delay
4757 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4759 yes | yes | yes | yes
4760 Arguments : none
4761
4762 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4763 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4764 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4765 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4766 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4767 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4768 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4769 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4770 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4771 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4772 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4773 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4774 affected.
4775
4776 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4777 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4778 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4779 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4780 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4781 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4782 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4783 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4784 latency environments.
4785
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004786 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
4787
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004788
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004789option http-pretend-keepalive
4790no option http-pretend-keepalive
4791 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 yes | yes | yes | yes
4794 Arguments : none
4795
4796 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4797 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4798 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4799 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4800 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4801 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4802 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4803 consider the response complete.
4804
4805 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4806 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4807 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4808 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4809 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4810 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4811
4812 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4813 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4814 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4815 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4816 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4817 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4818 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4819
4820 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4821 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004822 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004823 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4824 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004825
4826 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4827 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4828
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004829 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4830 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004831
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004832
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004833option http-server-close
4834no option http-server-close
4835 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4837 yes | yes | yes | yes
4838 Arguments : none
4839
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004840 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4841 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4842 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4843 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4844 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4845 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4846 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4847 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4848 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4849 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4850 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4851 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4852 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4853 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4854 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4855 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004856
4857 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4858 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4859 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4860 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004861 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4862 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004863
4864 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4865 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004866 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4867 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004868 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4869 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004870
4871 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4872 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4873
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004874 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004875 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4876 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004877
4878
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004879option http-tunnel
4880no option http-tunnel
4881 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4883 yes | yes | yes | yes
4884 Arguments : none
4885
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004886 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4887 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4888 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4889 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4890 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4891 "option http-tunnel".
4892
4893 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004894 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004895 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4896 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4897 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4898 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4899 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4900 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4901 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004902
4903 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4904 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4905
4906 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4907 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4908 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4909
4910
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004911option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004912no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004913 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4915 yes | yes | yes | no
4916 Arguments : none
4917
4918 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4919 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4920 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4921 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4922 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4923 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4924 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4925
4926 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4927 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4928 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4929 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4930 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4931 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4932 request along its whole life.
4933
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004934 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4935 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4936 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4937 front of an existing proxy.
4938
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004939 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4940
4941 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4942 http-server-close".
4943
4944
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004945option httpchk
4946option httpchk <uri>
4947option httpchk <method> <uri>
4948option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4949 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | no | yes | yes
4952 Arguments :
4953 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4954 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4955 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4956 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4957 ones.
4958
4959 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4960 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4961 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4962
4963 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4964 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4965 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4966 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4967 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4968
4969 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4970 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4971 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4972 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4973 the lack of any response.
4974
4975 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4976
4977 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4978 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4979 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4980
4981 Examples :
4982 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4983 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4984 backend https_relay
4985 mode tcp
4986 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4987 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4988
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004989 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4990 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4991 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004992
4993
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004994option httpclose
4995no option httpclose
4996 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4998 yes | yes | yes | yes
4999 Arguments : none
5000
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005001 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5002 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5003 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5004 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005005 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005006 "option http-tunnel".
5007
5008 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5009 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5010 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5011 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5012 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5013 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5014 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5015 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005016
5017 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005018 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005019 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5020 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5021 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5022 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5023 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005024
5025 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5026 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005027 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5028 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005029 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5030 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005031
5032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5034
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005035 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5036 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005037
5038
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005039option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005040 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5042 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005043 Arguments :
5044 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5045 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5046 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5047 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5048 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005049
5050 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5051 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5052 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5053 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5054 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5055 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5056 ports.
5057
5058 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5059
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005060 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5061 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005063 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005064
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005065
5066option http_proxy
5067no option http_proxy
5068 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5070 yes | yes | yes | yes
5071 Arguments : none
5072
5073 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5074 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5075 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5076 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5077 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5078
5079 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5080 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5081 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5082 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005083 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005084 be analyzed.
5085
5086 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5087 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5088
5089 Example :
5090 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5091 backend direct_forward
5092 option httpclose
5093 option http_proxy
5094
5095 See also : "option httpclose"
5096
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005097
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005098option independent-streams
5099no option independent-streams
5100 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5102 yes | yes | yes | yes
5103 Arguments : none
5104
5105 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5106 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5107 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5108 receive data or not.
5109
5110 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5111 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5112 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5113 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5114 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5115 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5116 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5117 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5118 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5119 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5120 socket buffers.
5121
5122 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5123 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5124 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5125 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5126 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5127
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005128 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005129 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5130 deprecated.
5131
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005132 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005133
5134
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005135option ldap-check
5136 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5138 yes | no | yes | yes
5139 Arguments : none
5140
5141 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5142 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5143 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5144 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5145
5146 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5147 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5148
5149 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5150 configure it.
5151
5152 Example :
5153 option ldap-check
5154
5155 See also : "option httpchk"
5156
5157
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005158option external-check
5159 Use external processes for server health checks
5160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5161 yes | no | yes | yes
5162
5163 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5164 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5165 command".
5166
5167 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5168
5169 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5170
5171
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005172option log-health-checks
5173no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005174 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5176 yes | no | yes | yes
5177 Arguments : none
5178
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005179 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5180 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5181 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005182
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005183 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5184 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5185 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5186 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5187 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5188
5189 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5190 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005191
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005192 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5193 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5194 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005195
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005196
5197option log-separate-errors
5198no option log-separate-errors
5199 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5201 yes | yes | yes | no
5202 Arguments : none
5203
5204 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5205 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5206 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5207 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5208 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5209 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5210 provides very important information.
5211
5212 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5213 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5214 error logs.
5215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005216 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005217 logging.
5218
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005219
5220option logasap
5221no option logasap
5222 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5224 yes | yes | yes | no
5225 Arguments : none
5226
5227 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5228 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5229 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5230 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5231 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5232 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5233 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005234 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005235 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5236 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5237
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005238 Examples :
5239 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5240 mode http
5241 option httplog
5242 option logasap
5243 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5244
5245 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5246 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5247 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5248 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005250 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005251 logging.
5252
5253
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005254option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005255 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5257 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005258 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005259 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5260 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005261 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005262
5263 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5264 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5265 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5266 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5267 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5268 in the MySQL table, like this :
5269
5270 USE mysql;
5271 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5272 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5273
5274 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5275 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5276 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5277 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5278 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5279 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5280 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5281 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5282 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5283
5284 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5285 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005286
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005287 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005288
5289 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5290 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5291 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5292 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5293 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5294 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5295
5296 See also: "option httpchk"
5297
5298
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005299option nolinger
5300no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005301 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005302 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5303 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005304 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005305
5306 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5307 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5308 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5309 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5310 connections.
5311
5312 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5313 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5314 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5315 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5316 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5317 this too.
5318
5319 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5320 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5321 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5322
5323 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5324 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5325 for servers.
5326
5327 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5328 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5329
5330
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005331option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5332 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5334 yes | yes | yes | yes
5335 Arguments :
5336 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5337 matching <network>
5338 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5339 header name.
5340
5341 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5342 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5343 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5344 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5345 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5346 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5347 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5348 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5349 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5350 possible that the client has already brought one.
5351
5352 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5353 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5354 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5355 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5356 header and requires different one.
5357
5358 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5359 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5360 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5361 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5362 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5363 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5364 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5365
5366 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5367 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5368 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5369 both are defined.
5370
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005371 Examples :
5372 # Original Destination address
5373 frontend www
5374 mode http
5375 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5376
5377 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5378 backend www
5379 mode http
5380 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5381
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005382 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5383 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005384
5385
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005386option persist
5387no option persist
5388 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5389 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5390 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005391 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005392
5393 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5394 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5395 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5396 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5397 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5398 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5399 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5400 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5401 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5402 redirected to another valid server.
5403
5404 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5405 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5406
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005407 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005408
5409
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005410option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5411 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5413 yes | no | yes | yes
5414 Arguments :
5415 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5416 PostgreSQL server.
5417
5418 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5419 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5420 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5421 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5422
5423 See also: "option httpchk"
5424
5425
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005426option prefer-last-server
5427no option prefer-last-server
5428 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5429 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5430 yes | no | yes | yes
5431 Arguments : none
5432
5433 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5434 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5435 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5436 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5437 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5438 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5439 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5440 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5441 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005442 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5443 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5444 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5445 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5446 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5447 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5448 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005449
5450 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5451 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5452
5453 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5454
5455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005456option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005457option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005458no option redispatch
5459 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5460 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5461 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005462 Arguments :
5463 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5464 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5465 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5466 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5467 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5468 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5469 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5470 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5471 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005473
5474 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5475 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5476 be able to access the service anymore.
5477
5478 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5479 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5480
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005481 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005482 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5483 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005485 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5486 "redisp" keywords.
5487
5488 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5489 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5490
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005491 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005492
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005493
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005494option redis-check
5495 Use redis health checks for server testing
5496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5497 yes | no | yes | yes
5498 Arguments : none
5499
5500 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5501 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5502 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5503 find the "+PONG" response message.
5504
5505 Example :
5506 option redis-check
5507
5508 See also : "option httpchk"
5509
5510
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005511option smtpchk
5512option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5513 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5515 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005516 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005517 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5518 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5519 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5520
5521 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5522 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5523 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5524
5525 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5526 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5527 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5528 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5529 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5530 dead server.
5531
5532 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5533 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5534 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5535 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5536
5537 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5538 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5539 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5540 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5541 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5542
5543 Example :
5544 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5545
5546 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005549option socket-stats
5550no option socket-stats
5551
5552 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5554 yes | yes | yes | no
5555
5556 Arguments : none
5557
5558
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005559option splice-auto
5560no option splice-auto
5561 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5563 yes | yes | yes | yes
5564 Arguments : none
5565
5566 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5567 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5568 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5569 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005570 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005571 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5572 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5573 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5574 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5575
5576 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5577 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5578 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5579 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5580 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5581 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5582 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5583 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5584 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5585 keyword.
5586
5587 Example :
5588 option splice-auto
5589
5590 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5591 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5592
5593 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5594 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5595
5596
5597option splice-request
5598no option splice-request
5599 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5601 yes | yes | yes | yes
5602 Arguments : none
5603
5604 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005605 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005606 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5607 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5608 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5609 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5610
5611 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5612
5613 Example :
5614 option splice-request
5615
5616 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5617 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5618
5619 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5620 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5621
5622
5623option splice-response
5624no option splice-response
5625 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5627 yes | yes | yes | yes
5628 Arguments : none
5629
5630 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005631 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005632 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5633 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5634 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5635 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5636
5637 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5638
5639 Example :
5640 option splice-response
5641
5642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5644
5645 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5646 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5647
5648
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005649option srvtcpka
5650no option srvtcpka
5651 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5653 yes | no | yes | yes
5654 Arguments : none
5655
5656 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5657 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5658 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5659 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5660
5661 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5662 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5663 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5664 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5665
5666 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5667 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5668 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5669 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5670 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5671
5672 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5673
5674 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5675 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5676 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5677
5678 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5679 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5680
5681 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5682
5683
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005684option ssl-hello-chk
5685 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5687 yes | no | yes | yes
5688 Arguments : none
5689
5690 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5691 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5692 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5693 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5694 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5695 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5696 hello message.
5697
5698 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5699 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5700 messages, which is appreciable.
5701
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005702 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5703 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5704 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005705
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005706 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5707
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005708
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005709option tcp-check
5710 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5711 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5712 yes | no | yes | yes
5713
5714 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5715 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5716
5717 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5718 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5719 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5720
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005721 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005722 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5723 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5724 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5725 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5726 only.
5727
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005728 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005729 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5730 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5731 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5732 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5733
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005734 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005735 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5736 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005737 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005738 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5739 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5740 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5741 the respective protocols.
5742 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5743 analysed.
5744
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005745 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
5746 script.
5747
5748 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
5749 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
5750 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
5751 The "comment" is of course optional.
5752
5753
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005754 Examples :
5755 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5756 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005757 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005758
5759 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5760 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005761 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005762
5763 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5764 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005765 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005766 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005767 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005768 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005769 tcp-check expect +PONGe
5770 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005771 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5772 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005773 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005774 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5775 tcp-check expect string +OK
5776
5777 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5778 (send many headers before analyzing)
5779 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005780 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005781 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5782 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5783 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5784 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005785 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005786
5787
5788 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5789
5790
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005791option tcp-smart-accept
5792no option tcp-smart-accept
5793 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5795 yes | yes | yes | no
5796 Arguments : none
5797
5798 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5799 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5800 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5801 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5802 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5803 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5804
5805 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5806 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5807 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5808 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5809
5810 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5811 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5812 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5813 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5814
5815 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5816 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5817 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5818
5819 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5820 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5821 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5822
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005823 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5824
5825
5826option tcp-smart-connect
5827no option tcp-smart-connect
5828 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5830 yes | no | yes | yes
5831 Arguments : none
5832
5833 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5834 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5835 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5836 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5837 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5838
5839 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5840 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5841 complex.
5842
5843 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5844 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5845 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5846
5847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5849
5850 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5851
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005852
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005853option tcpka
5854 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5856 yes | yes | yes | yes
5857 Arguments : none
5858
5859 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5860 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5861 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5862 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5863
5864 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5865 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5866 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5867 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5868
5869 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5870 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5871 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5872 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5873 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5874
5875 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5876
5877 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5878 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5879 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5880 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5881 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5882 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5883 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5884 backends.
5885
5886 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5887
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005888
5889option tcplog
5890 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5892 yes | yes | yes | yes
5893 Arguments : none
5894
5895 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5896 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5897 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5898 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5899 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5900 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5901 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5902 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5903
5904 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005906 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005907
5908
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005909option transparent
5910no option transparent
5911 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005913 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005914 Arguments : none
5915
5916 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5917 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5918 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5919 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5920 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5921 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5922 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5923 appropriate server.
5924
5925 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5926 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5927
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005928 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005929 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005930
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005931
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005932external-check command <command>
5933 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5935 yes | no | yes | yes
5936
5937 Arguments :
5938 <command> is the external command to run
5939
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005940 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5941
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005942 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005943
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005944 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5945 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5946 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5947 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5948 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5949 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005950
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005951 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5952
5953 Environment variables :
5954 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5955 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5956
5957 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5958
5959 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5960
5961 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5962 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5963 for a UNIX socket).
5964
5965 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5966
5967 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5968
5969 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5970
5971 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5972
5973 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5974
5975 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5976 socket).
5977
5978 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5979 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5980
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005981 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5982 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5983 failed.
5984
5985 Example :
5986 external-check command /bin/true
5987
5988 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5989
5990
5991external-check path <path>
5992 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5994 yes | no | yes | yes
5995
5996 Arguments :
5997 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5998
5999 The default path is "".
6000
6001 Example :
6002 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6003
6004 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6005 "external-check command"
6006
6007
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006008persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006009persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006010 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6012 yes | no | yes | yes
6013 Arguments :
6014 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006015 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6016 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006017
6018 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6019 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6020 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6021 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6022 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6023 forwarded to this server.
6024
6025 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6026 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6027 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006028 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006029 a single "listen" section.
6030
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006031 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6032 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6033 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6034
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006035 Example :
6036 listen tse-farm
6037 bind :3389
6038 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6039 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6040 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6041 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6042 persist rdp-cookie
6043 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006044 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006045 balance rdp-cookie
6046 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6047 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6048
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006049 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6050 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006051
6052
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006053rate-limit sessions <rate>
6054 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6056 yes | yes | yes | no
6057 Arguments :
6058 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6059 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6060
6061 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6062 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6063 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6064 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6065 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6066 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6067
6068 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6069 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6070 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6071 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6072
6073 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6074 listen smtp
6075 mode tcp
6076 bind :25
6077 rate-limit sessions 10
6078 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6079
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006080 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6081 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6082 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006083
6084 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6085
6086
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006087redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6088redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6089redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006090 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6092 no | yes | yes | yes
6093
6094 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006095 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006096
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006097 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006098 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006099 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6100 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6101 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006102
6103 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6104 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6105 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6106 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6107 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006108 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6109 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6110 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6111 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006112
6113 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6114 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6115 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6116 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6117 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6118 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006119 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006120 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006121 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6122 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6123 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006124
6125 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006126 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6127 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6128 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
6129 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
6130 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6131 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6132 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6133 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006134
6135 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6136 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6137
6138 - "drop-query"
6139 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6140 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6141 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6142 with a location-type redirect.
6143
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006144 - "append-slash"
6145 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6146 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6147 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6148 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6149
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006150 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6151 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6152 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6153 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6154 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6155 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6156 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6157
6158 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6159 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6160 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6161 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6162 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6163 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6164 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006165
6166 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6167 acl clear dst_port 80
6168 acl secure dst_port 8080
6169 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006170 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006171 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006172 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6173
6174 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006175 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6176 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6177 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006178 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006179
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006180 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6181 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6182 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6183
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006184 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006185 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006186
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006187 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6188 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6189 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006191 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006192
6193
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006194redisp (deprecated)
6195redispatch (deprecated)
6196 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6197 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6198 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006199 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006200
6201 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6202 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6203 be able to access the service anymore.
6204
6205 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6206 redistribute them to a working server.
6207
6208 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6209 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6210 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006212 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6213 "option redispatch" instead.
6214
6215 See also : "option redispatch"
6216
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006217
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006218reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006219 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6221 no | yes | yes | yes
6222 Arguments :
6223 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6224 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006225 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006226
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006227 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6228 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6229
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006230 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6231 the last header of an HTTP request.
6232
6233 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6234 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6235 responses.
6236
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006237 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6238 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6239 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6240
6241 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6242 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006243
6244
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006245reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6246reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006247 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6249 no | yes | yes | yes
6250 Arguments :
6251 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6252 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6253 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6254 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6255 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6256 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6257 ignores case.
6258
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006259 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6260 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6261
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006262 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6263 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6264 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6265 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006266 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006267
6268 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6269 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6270
6271 Example :
6272 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6273 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6274 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6275
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006276 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6277 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006278
6279
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006280reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6281reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006282 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6284 no | yes | yes | yes
6285 Arguments :
6286 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6287 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6288 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6289 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6290 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6291 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6292
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006293 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6294 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6295
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006296 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6297 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6298 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6299 next servers.
6300
6301 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6302 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6303 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6304
6305 Example :
6306 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6307 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6308 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6309
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006310 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6311 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006312
6313
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006314reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6315reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006316 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6318 no | yes | yes | yes
6319 Arguments :
6320 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6321 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6322 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6323 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6324 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6325 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6326 case.
6327
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006328 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6329 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6330
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006331 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6332 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6333 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6334 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006335 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006336
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006337 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006338 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006339 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006340
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006341 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6342 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6343
6344 Example :
6345 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6346 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6347 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6348
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006349 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6350 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006351
6352
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006353reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6354reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006355 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6357 no | yes | yes | yes
6358 Arguments :
6359 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6360 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6361 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6362 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6363 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6364 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6365 case.
6366
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006367 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6368 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6369
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006370 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6371 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6372 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6373 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6374
6375 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6376 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6377
6378 Example :
6379 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6380 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6381 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6382 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6383
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006384 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6385 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006386
6387
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006388reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6389reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006390 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6392 no | yes | yes | yes
6393 Arguments :
6394 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6395 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6396 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6397 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6398 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6399 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6400
6401 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6402 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6403 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6404 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006405 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006406
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006407 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6408 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6409
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006410 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6411 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6412 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6413
6414 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6415 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6416 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6417 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6418 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6419
6420 Example :
6421 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006422 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006423 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6424 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6425
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006426 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6427 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006428
6429
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006430reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6431reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006432 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6434 no | yes | yes | yes
6435 Arguments :
6436 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6437 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6438 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6439 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6440 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6441 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6442 ignores case.
6443
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006444 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6445 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6446
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006447 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6448 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006449 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6450 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6451 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006452 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6453 not set.
6454
6455 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6456 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6457 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6458 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6459 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6460
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006461 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006462 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6463 # block all others.
6464 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6465 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6466
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006467 # block bad guys
6468 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6469 reqitarpit . if badguys
6470
6471 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6472 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006473
6474
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006475retries <value>
6476 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6477 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6478 yes | no | yes | yes
6479 Arguments :
6480 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6481 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6482 default value is 3.
6483
6484 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6485 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6486 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6487
6488 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006489 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6490 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006491
6492 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6493 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6494
6495 See also : "option redispatch"
6496
6497
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006498rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006499 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6501 no | yes | yes | yes
6502 Arguments :
6503 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6504 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006505 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006506
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006507 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6508 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6509
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006510 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6511 the last header of an HTTP response.
6512
6513 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6514 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6515 responses.
6516
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006517 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6518 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006519
6520
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006521rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6522rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006523 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6525 no | yes | yes | yes
6526 Arguments :
6527 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6528 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6529 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6530 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6531 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6532 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6533 ignores case.
6534
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006535 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6536 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6537
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006538 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6539 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006540 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006541 client.
6542
6543 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6544 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6545 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6546
6547 Example :
6548 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006549 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006550
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006551 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6552 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006553
6554
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006555rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6556rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006557 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6559 no | yes | yes | yes
6560 Arguments :
6561 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6562 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6563 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6564 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6565 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6566 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6567 ignores case.
6568
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006569 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6570 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6571
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006572 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6573 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6574 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6575 case-sensitive.
6576
6577 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006578 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6579 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6580 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006581
6582 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6583 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6584
6585 Example :
6586 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6587 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6588
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006589 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6590 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006591
6592
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006593rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6594rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006595 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6597 no | yes | yes | yes
6598 Arguments :
6599 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6600 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6601 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6602 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6603 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6604 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6605 ignores case.
6606
6607 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6608 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6609 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6610 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006611 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006612
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006613 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6614 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6615
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006616 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6617 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6618 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6619
6620 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6621 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6622 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6623 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6624 are not case-sensitive.
6625
6626 Example :
6627 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6628 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6629
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006630 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6631 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006632
6633
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006634server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006635 Declare a server in a backend
6636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6637 no | no | yes | yes
6638 Arguments :
6639 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006640 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006641 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006642
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006643 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6644 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6645 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6646 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006647 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6648 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6649 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6650 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6651 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006652 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6653 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6654 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6655 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6656 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6657 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6658 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006659 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006660 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6661 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
6662 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006663
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006664 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006665 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6666 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6667 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6668 adding this value to the client's port.
6669
6670 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6671 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006672 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006673
6674 Examples :
6675 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6676 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006677 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006678 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
6679 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
6680 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006681
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006682 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6683 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006684
6685
6686source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006687source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006688source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006689 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6691 yes | no | yes | yes
6692 Arguments :
6693 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6694 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006695
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006696 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006697 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6698 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6699 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6700 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6701 supported prefixes are :
6702 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6703 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6704 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006705 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006706 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
6707 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006708
6709 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6710 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006711 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6712 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6713 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006714
6715 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6716 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6717 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6718 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6719 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6720 <addr>.
6721
6722 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6723 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6724 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6725 port.
6726
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006727 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6728 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6729 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6730 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006731 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006732 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6733 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6734 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6735 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6736 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6737 HTTP header.
6738
6739 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6740 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006741 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006742 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6743 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6744 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6745 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6746 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6747 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6748 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6749
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006750 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6751 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6752 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6753 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6754 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6755 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6756
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006757 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6758 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6759 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6760 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6761
6762 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6763 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6764 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6765 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6766 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6767 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6768
6769 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6770 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6771 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6772 there are two methods :
6773
6774 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6775 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6776 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6777 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6778 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6779 of the client ranges may be used.
6780
6781 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6782 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6783 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6784 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6785 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6786 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6787 same session.
6788
6789 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6790 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6791 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6792 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6793 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6794 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6795
6796 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6797 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6798 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006799 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006800
6801 Examples :
6802 backend private
6803 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6804 source 192.168.1.200
6805
6806 backend transparent_ssl1
6807 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6808 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6809
6810 backend transparent_ssl2
6811 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6812 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6813 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6814
6815 backend transparent_ssl3
6816 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6817 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6818 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6819
6820 backend transparent_smtp
6821 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6822 # with Tproxy version 4.
6823 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6824
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006825 backend transparent_http
6826 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6827 # proxy.
6828 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006830 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006831 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006833
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006834srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6835 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6837 yes | no | yes | yes
6838 Arguments :
6839 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6840 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6841 as explained at the top of this document.
6842
6843 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6844 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6845 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6846 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6847 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6848 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6849 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6850
6851 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6852 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6853 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6854 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6855 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006856 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006857 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006858 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006859
6860 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6861 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6862 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6863 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6864 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6865 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6866
6867 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6868 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6869
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006870 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6871 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006872
6873
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006874stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6875 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006877 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006878
6879 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6880 matched.
6881
6882 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6883 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6884
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006885 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6886 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6887 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6888
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006889 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6890 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6891 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6892 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006893
6894 Example :
6895 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6896 backend stats_localhost
6897 stats enable
6898 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6899
6900 Example :
6901 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6902 backend stats_auth
6903 stats enable
6904 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6905 stats admin if TRUE
6906
6907 Example :
6908 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6909 userlist stats-auth
6910 group admin users admin
6911 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6912 group readonly users haproxy
6913 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6914
6915 backend stats_auth
6916 stats enable
6917 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6918 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6919 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6920 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6921
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006922 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6923 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6924 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006925
6926
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006927stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6928 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006930 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006931 Arguments :
6932 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6933
6934 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6935
6936 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6937 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6938 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6939 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6940 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6941 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6942
6943 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6944 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6945 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006946 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006947
6948 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6949 report using "stats scope".
6950
6951 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6952 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6953 unobvious parameters.
6954
6955 Example :
6956 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6957 backend public_www
6958 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6959 stats enable
6960 stats hide-version
6961 stats scope .
6962 stats uri /admin?stats
6963 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6964 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6965 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6966
6967 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6968 backend private_monitoring
6969 stats enable
6970 stats uri /admin?stats
6971 stats refresh 5s
6972
6973 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6974
6975
6976stats enable
6977 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006979 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006980 Arguments : none
6981
6982 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6983 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6984 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6985 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6986 - stats auth : no authentication
6987 - stats scope : no restriction
6988
6989 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6990 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6991 unobvious parameters.
6992
6993 Example :
6994 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6995 backend public_www
6996 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6997 stats enable
6998 stats hide-version
6999 stats scope .
7000 stats uri /admin?stats
7001 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7002 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7003 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7004
7005 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7006 backend private_monitoring
7007 stats enable
7008 stats uri /admin?stats
7009 stats refresh 5s
7010
7011 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7012
7013
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007014stats hide-version
7015 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007017 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007018 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007019
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007020 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7021 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7022 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7023 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7024 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7025 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007026
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007027 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7028 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7029 unobvious parameters.
7030
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007031 Example :
7032 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7033 backend public_www
7034 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007035 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007036 stats hide-version
7037 stats scope .
7038 stats uri /admin?stats
7039 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7040 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7041 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007042
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007043 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7044 backend private_monitoring
7045 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007046 stats uri /admin?stats
7047 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007048
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007049 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007050
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007051
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007052stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7053 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7054 Access control for statistics
7055
7056 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7057 no | no | yes | yes
7058
7059 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7060 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7061 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7062 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7063 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7064 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7065
7066 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7067 instance.
7068
7069 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7070 about ACL usage.
7071
7072
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007073stats realm <realm>
7074 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007076 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007077 Arguments :
7078 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7079 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7080 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7081
7082 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7083 using a backslash ('\').
7084
7085 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7086 only related to authentication.
7087
7088 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7089 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7090 unobvious parameters.
7091
7092 Example :
7093 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7094 backend public_www
7095 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7096 stats enable
7097 stats hide-version
7098 stats scope .
7099 stats uri /admin?stats
7100 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7101 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7102 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7103
7104 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7105 backend private_monitoring
7106 stats enable
7107 stats uri /admin?stats
7108 stats refresh 5s
7109
7110 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7111
7112
7113stats refresh <delay>
7114 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007116 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007117 Arguments :
7118 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7119 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7120 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7121 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7122 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7123 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7124
7125 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7126 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7127 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7128 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7129
7130 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7131 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7132 unobvious parameters.
7133
7134 Example :
7135 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7136 backend public_www
7137 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7138 stats enable
7139 stats hide-version
7140 stats scope .
7141 stats uri /admin?stats
7142 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7143 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7144 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7145
7146 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7147 backend private_monitoring
7148 stats enable
7149 stats uri /admin?stats
7150 stats refresh 5s
7151
7152 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7153
7154
7155stats scope { <name> | "." }
7156 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007158 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007159 Arguments :
7160 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7161 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7162 section in which the statement appears.
7163
7164 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7165 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7166 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7167 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7168 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7169 exists.
7170
7171 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7172 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7173 unobvious parameters.
7174
7175 Example :
7176 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7177 backend public_www
7178 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7179 stats enable
7180 stats hide-version
7181 stats scope .
7182 stats uri /admin?stats
7183 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7184 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7185 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7186
7187 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7188 backend private_monitoring
7189 stats enable
7190 stats uri /admin?stats
7191 stats refresh 5s
7192
7193 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7194
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007195
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007196stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007197 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007199 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007200
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007201 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007202 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7203
7204 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7205 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7206
7207 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7208 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007209 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007210
7211 Example :
7212 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7213 backend private_monitoring
7214 stats enable
7215 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7216 stats uri /admin?stats
7217 stats refresh 5s
7218
7219 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7220 global section.
7221
7222
7223stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007224 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7226 yes | yes | yes | yes
7227 Arguments : none
7228
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007229 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007230 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7231 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7232 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7233 - IP (socket, server)
7234 - cookie (backend, server)
7235
7236 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7237 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007238 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007239
7240 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7241
7242
7243stats show-node [ <name> ]
7244 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007246 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007247 Arguments:
7248 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7249 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7250
7251 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7252 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007253 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007254
7255 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7256 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7257 unobvious parameters.
7258
7259 Example:
7260 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7261 backend private_monitoring
7262 stats enable
7263 stats show-node Europe-1
7264 stats uri /admin?stats
7265 stats refresh 5s
7266
7267 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7268 section.
7269
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007270
7271stats uri <prefix>
7272 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007274 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007275 Arguments :
7276 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7277 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7278 query string.
7279
7280 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7281 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7282 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7283 possible to reach it in the application.
7284
7285 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007286 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007287 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7288 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7289 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7290 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7291
7292 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7293 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7294 an address or a port to statistics only.
7295
7296 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7297 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7298 unobvious parameters.
7299
7300 Example :
7301 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7302 backend public_www
7303 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7304 stats enable
7305 stats hide-version
7306 stats scope .
7307 stats uri /admin?stats
7308 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7309 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7310 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7311
7312 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7313 backend private_monitoring
7314 stats enable
7315 stats uri /admin?stats
7316 stats refresh 5s
7317
7318 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7319
7320
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007321stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7322 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007324 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007325
7326 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007327 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007328 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7329 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7330 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7331
7332 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7333 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7334 the "stick-table" statement.
7335
7336 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7337 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7338 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7339 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7340 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7341
7342 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7343 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7344 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7345 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7346 transformation rules.
7347
7348 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7349 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7350 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7351 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7352 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7353 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7354 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7355
7356 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7357 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7358 ACL based conditions.
7359
7360 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7361 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7362 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7363 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7364
7365 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7366 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7367 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7368 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7369
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007370 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7371 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7372 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7373
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007374 Example :
7375 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7376 # last 30 minutes
7377 backend pop
7378 mode tcp
7379 balance roundrobin
7380 stick store-request src
7381 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7382 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7383 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7384
7385 backend smtp
7386 mode tcp
7387 balance roundrobin
7388 stick match src table pop
7389 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7390 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7391
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007392 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007393 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007394
7395
7396stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7397 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7399 no | no | yes | yes
7400
7401 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7402 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7403 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7404 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7405
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007406 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7407 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7408 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7409
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007410 Examples :
7411 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007412 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007413
7414 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7415 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7416 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7417
7418
7419 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7420 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7421 backend http
7422 mode http
7423 balance roundrobin
7424 stick on src table https
7425 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7426 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7427 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7428
7429 backend https
7430 mode tcp
7431 balance roundrobin
7432 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7433 stick on src
7434 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7435 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7436
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007437 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007438
7439
7440stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7441 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7443 no | no | yes | yes
7444
7445 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007446 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007447 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7448 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7449 server is selected.
7450
7451 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7452 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7453 the "stick-table" statement.
7454
7455 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7456 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7457 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7458 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7459 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7460 address.
7461
7462 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7463 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7464 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7465 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7466 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7467 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7468 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7469 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7470 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7471 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7472
7473 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7474 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7475 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7476 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7477 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7478 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7479 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7480
7481 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7482 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7483 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7484 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7485
7486 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7487 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7488 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7489 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7490 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7491 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007492 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7493 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7494 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7495 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7496 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7497 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007498
7499 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7500 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7501 the request.
7502
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007503 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7504 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7505 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7506
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007507 Example :
7508 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7509 # last 30 minutes
7510 backend pop
7511 mode tcp
7512 balance roundrobin
7513 stick store-request src
7514 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7515 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7516 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7517
7518 backend smtp
7519 mode tcp
7520 balance roundrobin
7521 stick match src table pop
7522 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7523 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7524
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007525 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007526 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007527
7528
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007529stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007530 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7531 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007532 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007534 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007535
7536 Arguments :
7537 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7538 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7539 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7540 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7541
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007542 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7543 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7544 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7545 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7546
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007547 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7548 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7549 instance.
7550
7551 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7552 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7553 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7554 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7555 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7556 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007557 to 32 characters.
7558
7559 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7560 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7561 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007562 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007563 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7564 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007565
7566 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007567 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7568 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007569 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7570 increase.
7571
7572 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007573 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7574 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7575 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007576
7577 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7578 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7579 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7580 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7581 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7582 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7583 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7584 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7585 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7586 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7587 parameter (see below).
7588
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007589 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7590 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7591 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7592 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7593 soft restart.
7594
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007595 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7596 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007597
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007598 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7599 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7600 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7601 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7602 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007603 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007604 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7605 if not expiration delay is specified.
7606
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007607 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7608 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7609 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7610 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007611 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7612 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7613 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7614 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7615 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7616 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7617 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7618 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7619 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7620 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7621 types and their arguments.
7622
7623 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7624 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7625 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7626 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7627
7628 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7629 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7630 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7631 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7632
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007633 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7634 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7635 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7636 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7637 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7638 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7639
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007640 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7641 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7642 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7643 they were received.
7644
7645 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7646 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7647 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7648 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7649 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7650
7651 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7652 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7653 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7654 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7655 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7656
7657 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7658 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7659 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7660
7661 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7662 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7663 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7664 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7665 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7666
7667 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7668 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7669 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7670 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7671 the client side.
7672
7673 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7674 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7675 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7676 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7677 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7678 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7679 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7680
7681 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7682 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7683 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7684 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7685 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7686 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7687 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7688
7689 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7690 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7691 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7692 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7693 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7694 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7695
7696 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7697 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7698 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7699 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7700
7701 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7702 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7703 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7704 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7705 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7706 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7707 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7708 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7709 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7710 recommended for better fairness.
7711
7712 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7713 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7714 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7715 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7716
7717 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7718 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7719 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7720 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7721 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7722 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7723 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7724 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7725 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7726 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007727
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007728 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7729 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007730 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7731 reference it.
7732
7733 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7734 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7735 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7736 as an exclusive stickiness.
7737
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007738 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7739 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7740 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7741 something that can be ignored.
7742
7743 Example:
7744 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7745 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7746 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7747 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7748
7749 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007750 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007751
7752
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007753stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7754 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7756 no | no | yes | yes
7757
7758 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007759 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007760 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7761 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7762 server is selected.
7763
7764 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7765 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7766 the "stick-table" statement.
7767
7768 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7769 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7770 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7771 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7772
7773 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7774 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7775 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7776 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7777 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7778 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007779 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007780 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7781 rules.
7782
7783 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7784 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7785 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7786 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7787 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7788 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7789 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7790
7791 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7792 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7793 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7794 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7795
7796 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7797 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7798 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7799 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7800 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7801 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007802 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7803 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7804 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7805 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7806 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7807 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7808 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7809 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7810 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007811
7812 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7813
7814 Example :
7815 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7816 backend https
7817 mode tcp
7818 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007819 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007820 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007821
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007822 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7823 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7824
7825 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7826 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7827 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7828
7829 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7830 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007831
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007832 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7833 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7834 # at offset 44.
7835
7836 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7837 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7838
7839 # Learn on response if server hello.
7840 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007841
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007842 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7843 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7844
7845 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7846 extraction.
7847
7848
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007849tcp-check connect [params*]
7850 Opens a new connection
7851 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7852 no | no | yes | yes
7853
7854 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7855 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7856 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7857
7858 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7859 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7860 of the sequence.
7861
7862 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7863 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7864 do.
7865
7866 Parameters :
7867 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7868 use the TCP connection.
7869
7870 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7871 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7872 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7873
7874 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7875
7876 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7877
7878 Examples:
7879 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7880 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7881 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7882 option tcp-check
7883 tcp-check connect
7884 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7885 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7886 tcp-check send \r\n
7887 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7888 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7889 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7890 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7891 tcp-check send \r\n
7892 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7893 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7894
7895 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7896 option tcp-check
7897 tcp-check connect port 110
7898 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7899 tcp-check connect port 143
7900 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7901 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7902
7903 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7904
7905
7906tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7907 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7909 no | no | yes | yes
7910
7911 Arguments :
7912 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7913 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7914 binary.
7915 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7916 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7917 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7918
7919 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7920 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7921 with the usual backslash ('\').
7922 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7923 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7924 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7925 used upper or lower case.
7926
7927
7928 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7929
7930 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7931 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7932 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7933 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7934 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7935 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7936 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7937 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7938
7939 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7940 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7941 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7942 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7943 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7944 expression.
7945
7946 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7947 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7948 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7949 this exact hexadecimal string.
7950 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7951
7952 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7953 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7954 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7955 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7956 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7957 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7958 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7959 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7960 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7961 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7962 the null character.
7963
7964 Examples :
7965 # perform a POP check
7966 option tcp-check
7967 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7968
7969 # perform an IMAP check
7970 option tcp-check
7971 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7972
7973 # look for the redis master server
7974 option tcp-check
7975 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7976 tcp-check expect +PONG
7977 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7978 tcp-check expect string role:master
7979 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7980 tcp-check expect string +OK
7981
7982
7983 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7984 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7985
7986
7987tcp-check send <data>
7988 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7990 no | no | yes | yes
7991
7992 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7993 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7994
7995 Examples :
7996 # look for the redis master server
7997 option tcp-check
7998 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7999 tcp-check expect string role:master
8000
8001 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8002 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8003
8004
8005tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8006 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8007 tcp health check
8008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8009 no | no | yes | yes
8010
8011 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8012 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8013 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8014 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8015 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8016 hexadecimal string.
8017 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8018
8019 Examples :
8020 # redis check in binary
8021 option tcp-check
8022 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8023 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8024
8025
8026 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8027 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8028
8029
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008030tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8031 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8033 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008034 Arguments :
8035 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008036 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
8037 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008038
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008039 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008040
8041 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8042 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008043 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8044 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8045 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8046 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8047 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8048 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008049
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008050 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8051 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8052 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8053 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008054
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008055 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008056 - accept :
8057 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8058 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8059 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008061 - reject :
8062 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8063 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8064 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8065 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8066 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8067 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8068 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8069 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8070 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8071 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8072 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8073 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008074
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008075 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8076 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8077 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8078 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8079 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8080 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8081 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8082 hosts.
8083
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008084 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8085 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8086 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8087 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8088 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8089 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8090 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8091 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8092 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008093 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8094 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008095
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008096 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008097 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008098 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008099 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008100 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8101 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008102 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008103 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8104 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8105 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8106 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8107 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008108
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008109 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008110 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008111 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008112 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8113 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8114 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8115 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008116
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008117 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8118 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8119 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8120 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008121
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008122 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8123 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8124 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8125 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8126 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008127 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8128 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8129 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8130 layer7 information is extracted.
8131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008132 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8133 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8134 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8135 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8136 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008138 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8139 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8140 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008141
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008142 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8143 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8144 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008145
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008146 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008147 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008148 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008149
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008150 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8151 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8152 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008153
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008154 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008155 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8156 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008157
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008158 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8159
8160 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8161
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008162 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8163
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008164 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008165
8166
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008167tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8168 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008170 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008171 Arguments :
8172 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008173 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008174 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
8175 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008176
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008177 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008178
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008179 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8180 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8181 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8182 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8183 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008184
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008185 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8186 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8187 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8188 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008189 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8190 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8191 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8192 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8193 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8194 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008195 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008196 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008197
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008198 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8199 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8200 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8201 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008202
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008203 Four types of actions are supported :
8204 - accept : the request is accepted
8205 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8206 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008207 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008208
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008209 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8210 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008211
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008212 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8213 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8214 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8215 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8216 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8217 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008219 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008220 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8221 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008222
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008223 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008224 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8225 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8226 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8227 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008228 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8229 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8230 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008231
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008232 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008233 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8234 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8235 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008236
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008237 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8238 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8239 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8240 documentation.
8241
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008242 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008243 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8244 # and reject everything else.
8245 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8246 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008247 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008248 tcp-request content reject
8249
8250 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008251 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8252 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8253 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008254 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008255
8256 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8257 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8258 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008259 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008260 tcp-request content reject
8261
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008262 Example:
8263 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8264 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008265 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008266
8267 Example:
8268 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8269 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008270 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008271
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008272 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8273 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8274
8275 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008276 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008277 # protecting all our sites
8278 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008279 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8280 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008281 ...
8282 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8283
8284 backend http_dynamic
8285 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008286 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008287 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008288 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8289 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8290 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008291 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008293 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008294
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008295 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008296
8297
8298tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8299 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008301 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008302 Arguments :
8303 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8304 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8305 as explained at the top of this document.
8306
8307 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8308 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8309 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8310 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8311 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8312
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008313 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8314 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8315 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8316 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8317
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008318 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8319 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008320 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008321 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008322 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8323 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8324 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8325 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008326
8327 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8328 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8329 it pass through unaffected.
8330
8331 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8332 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8333 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008334 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008335 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8336 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008337 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8338 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8339 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008340
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008341 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008342 "timeout client".
8343
8344
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008345tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8346 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8348 no | no | yes | yes
8349 Arguments :
8350 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008351 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008352
8353 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8354
8355 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8356 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8357 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008358 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8359 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008360
8361 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8362
8363 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8364 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8365 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8366 inserted.
8367
8368 Two types of actions are supported :
8369 - accept :
8370 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8371 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8372 the rules evaluation.
8373
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008374 - close :
8375 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8376 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8377 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8378 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8379 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8380 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008381 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008382 protocols.
8383
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008384 - reject :
8385 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8386 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008387 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008388
8389 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8390 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8391 for changing the default action to a reject.
8392
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008393 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8394 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8395 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8396 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008397 period.
8398
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008399 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8400 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8401 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8402 documentation.
8403
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008404 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8405
8406 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8407
8408
8409tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8410 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8412 no | no | yes | yes
8413 Arguments :
8414 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8415 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8416 as explained at the top of this document.
8417
8418 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8419
8420
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008421timeout check <timeout>
8422 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8423 established.
8424
8425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8426 yes | no | yes | yes
8427 Arguments:
8428 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8429 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8430 as explained at the top of this document.
8431
8432 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8433 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8434 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8435 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008436 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8437 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8438 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008439
8440 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8441 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8442
8443 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8444 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008445 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008446
8447 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8448 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8449 forget about it.
8450
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008451 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8452 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008453
8454
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008455timeout client <timeout>
8456timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8457 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8459 yes | yes | yes | no
8460 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008461 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008462 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8463 as explained at the top of this document.
8464
8465 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8466 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8467 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8468 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8469 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8470 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8471 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8472 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008473 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008474 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008475 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8476 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008477 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8478 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008479
8480 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8481 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8482 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8483 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8484 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8485 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8486
8487 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8488 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8489 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8490
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008491 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008492
8493
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008494timeout client-fin <timeout>
8495 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8497 yes | yes | yes | no
8498 Arguments :
8499 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8500 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8501 as explained at the top of this document.
8502
8503 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8504 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8505 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8506 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8507 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8508 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8509 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8510 down in one direction.
8511
8512 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8513 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8514 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8515
8516 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8517
8518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008519timeout connect <timeout>
8520timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8521 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8523 yes | no | yes | yes
8524 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008525 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008526 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8527 as explained at the top of this document.
8528
8529 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008530 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008531 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008532 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008533 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8534 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008535
8536 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8537 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8538 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8539 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8540 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8541 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8542
8543 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8544 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8545 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8546
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008547 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8548 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008549
8550
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008551timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8552 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8554 yes | yes | yes | yes
8555 Arguments :
8556 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8557 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8558 as explained at the top of this document.
8559
8560 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8561 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8562 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8563 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8564 once the request has started to present itself.
8565
8566 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8567 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8568 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8569 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8570 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8571
8572 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8573 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8574 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8575 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8576
8577 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8578 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8579 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8580 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8581 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008582 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008583
8584 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8585 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8586 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8587 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8588
8589 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8590
8591
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008592timeout http-request <timeout>
8593 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008595 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008596 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008597 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008598 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8599 as explained at the top of this document.
8600
8601 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8602 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8603 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8604 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8605 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8606 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8607 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008608 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8609 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8610 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8611 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8612 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008613 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8614 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008615
8616 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8617 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008618 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8619 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008620
8621 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8622 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8623 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8624 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8625 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8626
8627 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008628 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8629 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8630 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008631
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008632 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8633 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008634
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008635
8636timeout queue <timeout>
8637 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8639 yes | no | yes | yes
8640 Arguments :
8641 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8642 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8643 as explained at the top of this document.
8644
8645 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8646 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8647 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8648 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8649 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8650
8651 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8652 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8653 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8654 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8655
8656 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8657
8658
8659timeout server <timeout>
8660timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8661 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8663 yes | no | yes | yes
8664 Arguments :
8665 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8666 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8667 as explained at the top of this document.
8668
8669 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8670 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8671 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8672 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8673 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8674 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8675 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8676
8677 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8678 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8679 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8680 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8681 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008682 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008683 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008684 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8685 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8686 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8687 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008688
8689 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8690 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8691 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8692 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8693 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8694 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8695
8696 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8697 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8698 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8699
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008700 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008701
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008702
8703timeout server-fin <timeout>
8704 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8706 yes | no | yes | yes
8707 Arguments :
8708 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8709 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8710 as explained at the top of this document.
8711
8712 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8713 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8714 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8715 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8716 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8717 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8718 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8719 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8720 situations, it should not be needed.
8721
8722 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8723 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8724 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8725
8726 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8727
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008728
8729timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008730 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8732 yes | yes | yes | yes
8733 Arguments :
8734 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8735 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8736 as explained at the top of this document.
8737
8738 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8739 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8740 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8741
8742 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8743 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8744 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8745 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008746 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008747
8748 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8749
8750
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008751timeout tunnel <timeout>
8752 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8754 yes | no | yes | yes
8755 Arguments :
8756 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8757 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8758 as explained at the top of this document.
8759
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008760 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008761 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8762 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8763 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8764 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8765 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8766 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8767 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8768 specified.
8769
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008770 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8771 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8772 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8773 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8774 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8775 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8776 state.
8777
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008778 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8779 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8780 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8781 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8782 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8783
8784 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8785 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8786 forget about it.
8787
8788 Example :
8789 defaults http
8790 option http-server-close
8791 timeout connect 5s
8792 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008793 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008794 timeout server 30s
8795 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8796
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008797 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008798
8799
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008800transparent (deprecated)
8801 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008803 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008804 Arguments : none
8805
8806 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8807 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8808 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8809 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8810 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8811 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8812 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8813 appropriate server.
8814
8815 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8816
8817 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8818 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8819
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008820 See also: "option transparent"
8821
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008822unique-id-format <string>
8823 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8825 yes | yes | yes | no
8826 Arguments :
8827 <string> is a log-format string.
8828
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008829 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8830 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8831 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8832 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008833
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008834 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8835 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8836 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8837 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8838 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8839 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8840 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8841 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008842
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008843 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8844 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008845
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008846 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008847
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008848 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008849
8850 will generate:
8851
8852 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8853
8854 See also: "unique-id-header"
8855
8856unique-id-header <name>
8857 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8859 yes | yes | yes | no
8860 Arguments :
8861 <name> is the name of the header.
8862
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008863 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8864 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008865
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008866 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008867
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008868 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008869 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8870
8871 will generate:
8872
8873 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8874
8875 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008876
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008877use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008878 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8880 no | yes | yes | no
8881 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008882 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8883 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008884
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008885 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8886 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008887
8888 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8889 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8890 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008891 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8892 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8893 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8894 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008895
8896 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8897 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8898 assign the backend.
8899
8900 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8901 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8902 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8903 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8904 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8905 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8906
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008907 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008908 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008909 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8910 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8911 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8912
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008913 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8914 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8915 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8916 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8917 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8918 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8919 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8920 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8921 cannot be forced from the request.
8922
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008923 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008924 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8925 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8926
8927 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8928 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008929
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008930
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008931use-server <server> if <condition>
8932use-server <server> unless <condition>
8933 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8935 no | no | yes | yes
8936 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008937 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008938
8939 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8940
8941 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8942 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8943 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8944
8945 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8946 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8947 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8948 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8949 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8950 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8951 matches will assign the server.
8952
8953 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8954 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8955 with the next rules until one matches.
8956
8957 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8958 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8959 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8960 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8961
8962 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8963 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8964 stripped.
8965
8966 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8967 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8968 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8969 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8970
8971 Example :
8972 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8973 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8974 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8975 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8976 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8977 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8978 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8979 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8980 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8981
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008982 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008983
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008984
89855. Bind and Server options
8986--------------------------
8987
8988The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8989depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8990settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8991written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8992described in this section.
8993
8994
89955.1. Bind options
8996-----------------
8997
8998The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8999as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9000no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9001parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9002while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9003provided immediately after the setting name.
9004
9005The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9006
9007accept-proxy
9008 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009009 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9010 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009011 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9012 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9013 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9014 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9015 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9016 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9017 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009018 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9019 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009020
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009021alpn <protocols>
9022 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9023 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9024 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9025 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9026 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9027 initial NPN extension.
9028
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009029backlog <backlog>
9030 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9031 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9032
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009033ecdhe <named curve>
9034 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009035 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9036 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009037
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009038ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009039 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9040 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9041 client's certificate.
9042
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009043ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9044 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9045 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9046 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9047 error is ignored.
9048
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009049ca-sign-file <cafile>
9050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9051 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9052 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9053 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9054 'generate-certificates' for details.
9055
9056ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9057 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9058 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9059 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9060 'generate-certificates' for details.
9061
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009062ciphers <ciphers>
9063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9064 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009065 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009066 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9067 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9068
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009069crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9071 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9072 to verify client's certificate.
9073
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009074crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009075 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9076 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9077 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9078 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9079 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9080 file.
9081
9082 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9083 are loaded.
9084
9085 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009086 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009087 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9088 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9089 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9090 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9091 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9092 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9093 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009094
9095 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9096 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9097 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9098 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009099 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9100 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009101
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009102 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009103
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009104 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9105 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009106 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009107 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9108 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9109 clients).
9110
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009111 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9112 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9113 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9114 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9115 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9116 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9117 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9118 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9119 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9120 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9121 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9122 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9123 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9124
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009125 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9126 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9127 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9128 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9129 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9130
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009131crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9133 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009134 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009135 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009136
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009137crt-list <file>
9138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009139 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9140 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009141
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009142 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009143
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009144 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9145 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9146 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9147 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9148 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9149 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9150 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9151 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009152
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009153defer-accept
9154 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9155 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9156 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9157 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9158 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9159 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9160 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9161 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9162 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9163 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9164 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9165
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009166force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009167 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009168 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009169 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9170 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009171
9172force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009173 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009174 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9175 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009176
9177force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009178 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009179 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9180 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009181
9182force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009183 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009184 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9185 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009186
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009187generate-certificates
9188 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9189 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9190 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9191 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9192 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9193 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9194 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9195 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9196 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9197 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9198 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9199
9200 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9201 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9202 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9203 certificate is used many times.
9204
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009205gid <gid>
9206 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9207 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9208 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9209 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9210 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9211
9212group <group>
9213 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9214 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9215 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9216 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9217 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9218
9219id <id>
9220 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9221 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9222 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9223 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9224
9225interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009226 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9227 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9228 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9229 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9230 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9231 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9232 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009233
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009234level <level>
9235 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9236 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9237 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9238 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9239 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9240 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9241 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9242 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9243 counters).
9244 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9245 all counters).
9246
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009247maxconn <maxconn>
9248 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9249 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9250 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9251 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9252 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9253 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9254 eat all memory.
9255
9256mode <mode>
9257 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9258 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9259 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9260 UNIX sockets.
9261
9262mss <maxseg>
9263 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9264 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9265 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9266 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9267 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9268 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9269 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9270 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9271 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9272 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9273 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9274
9275name <name>
9276 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9277 page.
9278
9279nice <nice>
9280 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9281 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9282 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9283 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9284 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9285 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9286 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9287 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9288 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9289 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9290 one for an RDP socket.
9291
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009292no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009294 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009295 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009296 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9297 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009298 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009299
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009300no-tls-tickets
9301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9302 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9303 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009304 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9305 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009306
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009307no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009309 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009310 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009311 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9312 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9313 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009314
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009315no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009317 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009318 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009319 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9320 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9321 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009322
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009323no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009324 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009325 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009326 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009327 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9328 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9329 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009330
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009331npn <protocols>
9332 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9333 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9334 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9335 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009336 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9337 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009338
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009339process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9340 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9341 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9342 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9343 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9344 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9345 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9346 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009347 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9348 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9349 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9350 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9351 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9352 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9353 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009354
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009355ssl
9356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009357 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009358 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9359 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9360 to deciphered contents.
9361
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009362strict-sni
9363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9364 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9365 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9366 See the "crt" option for more information.
9367
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009368tcp-ut <delay>
9369 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9370 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9371 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9372 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9373 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9374 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9375 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9376 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9377 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9378 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9379 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9380
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009381tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009382 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009383 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9384 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9385 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9386 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9387 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9388 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9389 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009390 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9391 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9392 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009393
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009394tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9395 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9396 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9397 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9398 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9399 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9400 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9401 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9402 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9403 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9404 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9405
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009406transparent
9407 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9408 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9409 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9410 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9411 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9412 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9413 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9414 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9415 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9416 so check for support with your vendor.
9417
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009418v4v6
9419 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9420 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9421 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9422 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009423 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009424
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009425v6only
9426 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9427 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9428 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009429 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9430 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009431
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009432uid <uid>
9433 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9434 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9435 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9436 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9437 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9438
9439user <user>
9440 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9441 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9442 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9443 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9444 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9445
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009446verify [none|optional|required]
9447 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9448 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9449 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9450 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9451 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009452 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9453 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9454 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9455 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009456
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020094575.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009458------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009459
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009460The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9461which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9462arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9463settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9464after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9465Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9466address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009468 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009469 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009471The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009472
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009473addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009474 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9475 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9476 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9477 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9478 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009479
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009480 Supported in default-server: No
9481
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009482agent-check
9483 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009484 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9485 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9486 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9487 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009488
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009489 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009490 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009491 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9492 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9493 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009494
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009495 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9496 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009497
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009498 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9499 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9500 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009501
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009502 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9503 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9504 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009505
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009506 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9507 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9508 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9509 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9510 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9511 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9512 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009513
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009514 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9515 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009516
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009517 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9518 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9519 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9520 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9521 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9522 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9523 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9524 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9525 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009526
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009527 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9528 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009529 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9530 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9531 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9532 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009533
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009534 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9535 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009536
9537 Supported in default-server: No
9538
9539agent-inter <delay>
9540 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9541 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9542
9543 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9544 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9545 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9546 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9547 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9548 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9549 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9550 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9551 of backends use the same servers.
9552
9553 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9554
9555 Supported in default-server: Yes
9556
9557agent-port <port>
9558 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9559
9560 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9561
9562 Supported in default-server: Yes
9563
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009564backup
9565 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9566 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9567 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9568 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9569 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9570 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009572 Supported in default-server: No
9573
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009574ca-file <cafile>
9575 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9576 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9577 server's certificate.
9578
9579 Supported in default-server: No
9580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009581check
9582 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009583 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9584 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9585 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9586 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9587 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9588 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9589 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009590 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9591 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9592 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009594 Supported in default-server: No
9595
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009596check-send-proxy
9597 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9598 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9599 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9600 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9601 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9602 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9603 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9604
9605 Supported in default-server: No
9606
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009607check-ssl
9608 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9609 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9610 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9611 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009612 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009613 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9614 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9615 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9616 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9617
9618 Supported in default-server: No
9619
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009620ciphers <ciphers>
9621 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009622 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009623 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9624 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9625 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9626 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9627 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9628 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9629
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009630 Supported in default-server: No
9631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009632cookie <value>
9633 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9634 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9635 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9636 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9637 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9638 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9639 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009641 Supported in default-server: No
9642
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009643crl-file <crlfile>
9644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9645 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9646 to verify server's certificate.
9647
9648 Supported in default-server: No
9649
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009650crt <cert>
9651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9652 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9653 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9654 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9655 certificate request.
9656
9657 Supported in default-server: No
9658
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009659disabled
9660 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9661 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9662 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9663 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9664 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9665
9666 Supported in default-server: No
9667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009668error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009669 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9670 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9671 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009673 Supported in default-server: Yes
9674
9675 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009677fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009678 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9679 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9680 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009682 Supported in default-server: Yes
9683
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009684force-sslv3
9685 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9686 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009687 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9688 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009689
9690 Supported in default-server: No
9691
9692force-tlsv10
9693 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009694 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9695 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009696
9697 Supported in default-server: No
9698
9699force-tlsv11
9700 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009701 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9702 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009703
9704 Supported in default-server: No
9705
9706force-tlsv12
9707 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009708 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9709 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009710
9711 Supported in default-server: No
9712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009713id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009714 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9715 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9716 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009718 Supported in default-server: No
9719
9720inter <delay>
9721fastinter <delay>
9722downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009723 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9724 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9725 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9726 between checks depending on the server state :
9727
9728 Server state | Interval used
9729 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9730 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9731 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9732 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9733 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9734 or yet unchecked. |
9735 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9736 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9737 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009739 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9740 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9741 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9742 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009743 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9744 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9745 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9746 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9747 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009749 Supported in default-server: Yes
9750
9751maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009752 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9753 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9754 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9755 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9756 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9757 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9758 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9759 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9760
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009761 Supported in default-server: Yes
9762
9763maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009764 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9765 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9766 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9767 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9768 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9769 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9770 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009772 Supported in default-server: Yes
9773
9774minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009775 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9776 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9777 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9778 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9779 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9780 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009781 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009782 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009784 Supported in default-server: Yes
9785
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009786no-ssl-reuse
9787 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9788 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9789 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9790 and for paranoid users.
9791
9792 Supported in default-server: No
9793
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009794no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009795 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9796 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009797 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009798
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009799 Supported in default-server: No
9800
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009801no-tls-tickets
9802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9803 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9804 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009805 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9806 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009807
9808 Supported in default-server: No
9809
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009810no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009811 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009812 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9813 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009814 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9815 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9816 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009817
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009818 Supported in default-server: No
9819
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009820no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009821 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009822 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9823 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009824 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9825 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9826 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009827
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009828 Supported in default-server: No
9829
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009830no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009831 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009832 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9833 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009834 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9835 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9836 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009837
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009838 Supported in default-server: No
9839
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009840non-stick
9841 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9842 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9843 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9844
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009845 Supported in default-server: No
9846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009847observe <mode>
9848 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9849 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9850 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9851 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9852 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9853 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009854 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009855
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009856 Supported in default-server: No
9857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009858 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009860on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009861 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9862 Currently, four modes are available:
9863 - fastinter: force fastinter
9864 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9865 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9866 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9867 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9868
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009869 Supported in default-server: Yes
9870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009871 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9872
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009873on-marked-down <action>
9874 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9875 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009876 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9877 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9878 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9879 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9880 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9881 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9882 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9883 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009884
9885 Actions are disabled by default
9886
9887 Supported in default-server: Yes
9888
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009889on-marked-up <action>
9890 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9891 Currently one action is available:
9892 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9893 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9894 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9895 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9896 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9897 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9898 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9899 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9900
9901 Actions are disabled by default
9902
9903 Supported in default-server: Yes
9904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009905port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009906 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9907 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9908 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9909 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9910 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9911 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009913 Supported in default-server: Yes
9914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009915redir <prefix>
9916 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9917 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9918 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9919 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9920 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9921 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9922 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9923 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009924 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009925 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9926 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9927 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9928 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9929 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9930
9931 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009933 Supported in default-server: No
9934
9935rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009936 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9937 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9938 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9939
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009940 Supported in default-server: Yes
9941
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009942send-proxy
9943 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9944 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9945 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9946 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9947 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9948 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9949 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9950 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9951 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009952 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9953 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9954 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9955 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9956 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009957
9958 Supported in default-server: No
9959
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009960send-proxy-v2
9961 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9962 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9963 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9964 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9965 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9966 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9967 option of the "bind" keyword.
9968
9969 Supported in default-server: No
9970
9971send-proxy-v2-ssl
9972 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9973 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9974 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9975 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9976 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9977 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9978 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9979 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9980
9981 Supported in default-server: No
9982
9983send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9984 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9985 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9986 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9987 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9988 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9989 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9990 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9991 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9992 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9993
9994 Supported in default-server: No
9995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009996slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009997 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9998 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9999 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10000 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10001 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10002 parameters :
10003
10004 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10005 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10006
10007 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10008 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10009 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10010 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10011
10012 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10013 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10014 seen as failed.
10015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010016 Supported in default-server: Yes
10017
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010018source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010019source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010020source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010021 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10022 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10023 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10024 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10025
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010026 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10027 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10028 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10029 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10030 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10031 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10032 server.
10033
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010034 Supported in default-server: No
10035
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010036ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010037 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10038 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10039 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10040 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10041 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10042 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010043 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010044
10045 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010047track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010048 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10049 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10050 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10051 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010052 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010054 Supported in default-server: No
10055
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010056verify [none|required]
10057 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010058 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10059 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10060 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10061 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010062 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10063 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10064 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010065
10066 Supported in default-server: No
10067
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010068verifyhost <hostname>
10069 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10070 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10071 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10072 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10073 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10074 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10075
10076 Supported in default-server: No
10077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010078weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010079 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10080 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10081 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010082 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10083 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10084 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10085 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10086 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10087 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010089 Supported in default-server: Yes
10090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010091
100926. HTTP header manipulation
10093---------------------------
10094
10095In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10096response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10097request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10098which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010099against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010100
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010101If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10102to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10103but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10104HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10105stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10106because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10107a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10108still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010110This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10111in section 4.2 :
10112
10113 - reqadd <string>
10114 - reqallow <search>
10115 - reqiallow <search>
10116 - reqdel <search>
10117 - reqidel <search>
10118 - reqdeny <search>
10119 - reqideny <search>
10120 - reqpass <search>
10121 - reqipass <search>
10122 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10123 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10124 - reqtarpit <search>
10125 - reqitarpit <search>
10126 - rspadd <string>
10127 - rspdel <search>
10128 - rspidel <search>
10129 - rspdeny <search>
10130 - rspideny <search>
10131 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10132 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10133
10134With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10135is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10136parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10137prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10138Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10139
10140 \t for a tab
10141 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10142 \n for a new line (LF)
10143 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10144 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10145 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10146 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10147 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10148
10149The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10150portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10151above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10152regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
101539 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10154is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10155
10156The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10157after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10158
10159Notes related to these keywords :
10160---------------------------------
10161 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10162 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10163 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10164
10165 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10166 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10167 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10168
10169 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10170 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10171 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10172 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10173 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10174
10175 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10176 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10177 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10178 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10179 useless headers before adding new ones.
10180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010181 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010182 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10183
10184 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10185 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10186 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10187
10188 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10189 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010190 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010191
10192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101937. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10194----------------------------------
10195
10196Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10197client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10198The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10199these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10200but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10201data called patterns.
10202
10203
102047.1. ACL basics
10205---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010206
10207The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10208content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10209from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10210simple :
10211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010212 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010213 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010214 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10215 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010217The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10218adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010219
10220In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010222 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010223
10224This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10225Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10226and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010227an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10228conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10229as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10230are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010231
10232ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10233'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10234which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10235
10236There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10237performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010239The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10240specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10241this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010242methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10243ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010244
10245Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10246 - boolean
10247 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10248 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10249 - string
10250 - data block
10251
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010252Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10253converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10254would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10255The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10256which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10257
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010258Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10259keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10260fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10261which are summarized in the table below :
10262
10263 +---------------------+-----------------+
10264 | Sample or converter | Default |
10265 | output type | matching method |
10266 +---------------------+-----------------+
10267 | boolean | bool |
10268 +---------------------+-----------------+
10269 | integer | int |
10270 +---------------------+-----------------+
10271 | ip | ip |
10272 +---------------------+-----------------+
10273 | string | str |
10274 +---------------------+-----------------+
10275 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10276 +---------------------+-----------------+
10277
10278Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10279matching method, see below.
10280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010281The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10282 - boolean
10283 - integer or integer range
10284 - IP address / network
10285 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10286 - regular expression
10287 - hex block
10288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010289The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10290
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010291 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10292 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010293 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010294 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010295 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010296 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010297 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010299The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10300read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10301if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10302lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10303will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10304beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10305a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10306lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10307exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10308
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010309The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10310parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10311ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10312a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10313check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10314
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010315The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10316socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10317file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010319Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10320loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10321
10322 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10323
10324In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10325the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10326case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10327as well.
10328
10329The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10330sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10331do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10332methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10333is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10334obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10335followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10336default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10337that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10338string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10339
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010340The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10341By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10342string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10343resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10344server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10345waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10346flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10347function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010349There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10350sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10351be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010352
10353 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10354 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010355 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10356 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10357 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10358 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010359
10360 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10361 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010362 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010363
10364 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010365 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010366
10367 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010368 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010369
10370 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10371 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10372
10373 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10374 binary or string samples.
10375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010376 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10377 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010379 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10380 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10381 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010383 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10384 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010386 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10387 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010389 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10390 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010392 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10393 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010394 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010396 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10397 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10398 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010399
10400For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10401request, it is possible to do :
10402
10403 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10404
10405In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10406buffer, one would use the following acl :
10407
10408 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10409
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010410On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10411possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10412
10413 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010415All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10416criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10417method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10418to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10419criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10420the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010422If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010423the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10424For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010426 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10427 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10428 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10429 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010430
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010431
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010432The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10433types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10434combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10435brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10436default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010438 +-------------------------------------------------+
10439 | Input sample type |
10440 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010441 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010442 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10443 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10444 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010445 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010446 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010447 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010448 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010449 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010450 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010451 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010452 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010453 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010454 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010455 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010456 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010457 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010458 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010459 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010460 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010461 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010462 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010463 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010464 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010465 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010466 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10467 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10468 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010469
10470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104717.1.1. Matching booleans
10472------------------------
10473
10474In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10475Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10476When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10477that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10478
10479Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10480return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10481"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10482
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104847.1.2. Matching integers
10485------------------------
10486
10487Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10488enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10489to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10490
10491Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10492matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10493lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010494
10495For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10496unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10497representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10498
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010499As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10500two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10501instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10502ranges and operators.
10503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010504For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010505operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10506Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10507of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010508
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010509Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010510
10511 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10512 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10513 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10514 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10515 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010517For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010518
10519 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10520
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010521This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10522
10523 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10524
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200105267.1.3. Matching strings
10527-----------------------
10528
10529String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10530different forms :
10531
10532 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10533 patterns ;
10534
10535 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10536 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10537
10538 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10539 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10540
10541 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10542 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10543
10544 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10545 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10546 matches.
10547
10548 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10549 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10550 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010551
10552String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10553exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10554characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10555string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10556to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010557before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010558
10559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200105607.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10561---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010562
10563Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10564they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10565possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10566passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10567the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010568the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10569match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010570
10571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200105727.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10573-------------------------------------
10574
10575It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10576not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10577a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10578to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10579digits may be used upper or lower case.
10580
10581Example :
10582 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10583 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10584
10585
105867.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10587---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010588
10589IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10590netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10591within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010592host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010593difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10594at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10595does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10596parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010597
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010598IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10599Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10600trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10601IPv6 patterns.
10602
10603HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10604following situations :
10605 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10606 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10607 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10608 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10609 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10610 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10611 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10612 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10613 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10614 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010616
106177.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10618----------------------------------
10619
10620Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10621combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10622
10623 - AND (implicit)
10624 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10625 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010627A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010629 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010631Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10632indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010634For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10635"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10636requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10637is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10638
10639 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10640 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10641 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10642 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10643
10644To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10645and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10646
10647 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10648 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10649 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10650 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10651
10652 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10653 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10654 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10655 use_backend www if host_www
10656
10657It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10658expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10659be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10660the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10661
10662 The following rule :
10663
10664 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10665 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10666
10667 Can also be written that way :
10668
10669 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10670
10671It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10672to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10673simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10674sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10675good use is the following :
10676
10677 With named ACLs :
10678
10679 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10680 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10681 monitor fail if site_dead
10682
10683 With anonymous ACLs :
10684
10685 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10686
10687See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10688
10689
106907.3. Fetching samples
10691---------------------
10692
10693Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10694against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10695sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10696ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10697of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10698available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10699
10700This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10701Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10702compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10703deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10704
10705The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10706matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10707method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10708indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10709
10710As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10711when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10712mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10713the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10714ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10715
10716Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10717multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10718when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10719incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10720are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10721is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10722all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10723
10724Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10725 - name
10726 - name(arg1)
10727 - name(arg1,arg2)
10728
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010729
107307.3.1. Converters
10731-----------------
10732
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010733Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10734of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10735is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10736was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10737has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10738unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10739
10740These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10741sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10742the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10743support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010744
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010745A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10746support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10747supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10748(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10749bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010751The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010752
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010753add(<value>)
10754 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10755 result as an unsigned integer.
10756
10757and(<value>)
10758 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10759 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10760
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010761base64
10762 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10763 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10764 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10765
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010766bool
10767 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10768 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10769 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10770 presence of a flag).
10771
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010772bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10773 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10774 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10775 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10776
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010777cpl
10778 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10779 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10780
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010781crc32([<avalanche>])
10782 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10783 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10784 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10785 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10786 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10787 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10788 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10789 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10790 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10791 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10792 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10793
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020010794da-csv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
10795 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
10796 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
10797 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
10798 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
10799 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
10800 configuration language.
10801
10802 Example:
10803 frontend www
10804 bind *:8881
10805 default_backend servers
10806 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
10807
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010808div(<value>)
10809 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10810 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10811 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10812
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010813djb2([<avalanche>])
10814 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10815 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10816 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10817 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10818 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10819 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10820 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010821 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10822 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010823
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010824even
10825 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10826 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10827
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010828field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10829 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10830 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10831 list of chars.
10832
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010833hex
10834 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10835 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10836 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10837 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010838
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010839http_date([<offset>])
10840 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10841 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10842 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10843 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10844 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10845 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010846
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010847in_table(<table>)
10848 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10849 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10850 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10851 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10852 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10853
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010854ipmask(<mask>)
10855 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10856 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10857 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10858 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10859
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010860json([<input-code>])
10861 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10862 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10863 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10864 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10865 of errors:
10866 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10867 bytes, ...)
10868 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10869 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10870
10871 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10872 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10873 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10874 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10875 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10876 are :
10877 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10878 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10879 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10880 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10881 error ;
10882 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10883 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10884
10885 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10886 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10887
10888 Example:
10889 capture request header user-agent len 150
10890 capture request header Host len 15
10891 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10892
10893 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10894 GET / HTTP/1.0
10895 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10896
10897 Output log:
10898 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10899
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010900language(<value>[,<default>])
10901 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10902 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10903 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10904 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10905 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10906 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10907 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10908 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10909 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10910 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10911 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10912 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010913
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010914 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010915
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010916 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10917 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010918
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010919 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10920 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10921 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10922 use_backend spanish if es
10923 use_backend french if fr
10924 use_backend english if en
10925 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010926
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010927lower
10928 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10929 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10930 type. The result is of type string.
10931
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010932ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10933 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10934 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10935 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10936 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10937 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10938 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10939
10940 Example :
10941
10942 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10943 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10944 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10945
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010946map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10947map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10948map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10949 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10950 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10951 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10952 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10953 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10954 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10955 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10956 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010957
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010958 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10959 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10960 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010961
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010962 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10963 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010964
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010965 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10966 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10967 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10968 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010969 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10970 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010971 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10972 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10973 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10974 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10975 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10976 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10977 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10978 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10979 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10980 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10981 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10982 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10983 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10984 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010985
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010986 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10987 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10988 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10989 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10990 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010991
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010992 Example :
10993
10994 # this is a comment and is ignored
10995 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10996 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10997 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10998 | | | `---------- value
10999 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11000 | `---------------------------- key
11001 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11002
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011003mod(<value>)
11004 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
11005 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
11006
11007mul(<value>)
11008 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
11009 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
11010 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
11011
11012neg
11013 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
11014 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
11015 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
11016 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
11017
11018not
11019 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
11020 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11021 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11022 absence of a flag).
11023
11024odd
11025 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
11026 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11027
11028or(<value>)
11029 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
11030 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11031
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011032regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011033 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11034 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11035 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11036 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11037 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11038 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11039 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11040 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11041 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11042 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
11043 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
11044 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
11045 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
11046
11047 Example :
11048
11049 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11050 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11051 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11052 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11053
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011054capture-req(<id>)
11055 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11056 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11057
11058 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11059 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11060 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11061
11062capture-res(<id>)
11063 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11064 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11065
11066 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11067 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11068 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11069
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011070sdbm([<avalanche>])
11071 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
11072 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11073 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11074 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11075 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11076 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11077 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011078 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
11079 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011080
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011081sub(<value>)
11082 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
11083 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
11084 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
11085
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011086table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
11087 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11088 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11089 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
11090 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11091 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11092 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
11093
11094
11095table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
11096 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11097 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11098 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
11099 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11100 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11101 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
11102
11103table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11104 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11105 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11106 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11107 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11108 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11109
11110table_conn_cur(<table>)
11111 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11112 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11113 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11114 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11115 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11116
11117table_conn_rate(<table>)
11118 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11119 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11120 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11121 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11122 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11123
11124table_gpc0(<table>)
11125 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11126 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11127 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11128 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11129 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11130
11131table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11132 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11133 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11134 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11135 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11136 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11137 sample fetch keyword.
11138
11139table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11140 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11141 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11142 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11143 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11144 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11145
11146table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11147 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11148 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11149 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11150 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11151 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11152 keyword.
11153
11154table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11155 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11156 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11157 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11158 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11159 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11160
11161table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11162 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11163 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11164 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11165 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11166 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11167 keyword.
11168
11169table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11170 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11171 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11172 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11173 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11174 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11175 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11176 keyword.
11177
11178table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11179 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11180 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11181 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11182 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11183 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11184 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11185 keyword.
11186
11187table_server_id(<table>)
11188 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11189 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11190 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
11191 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
11192 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
11193 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
11194
11195table_sess_cnt(<table>)
11196 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11197 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11198 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11199 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
11200 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11201 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
11202 keyword.
11203
11204table_sess_rate(<table>)
11205 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11206 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11207 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
11208 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
11209 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11210 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
11211 keyword.
11212
11213table_trackers(<table>)
11214 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11215 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11216 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11217 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
11218 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
11219 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
11220 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
11221 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
11222 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
11223 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
11224
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011225upper
11226 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
11227 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11228 type. The result is of type string.
11229
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020011230url_dec
11231 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
11232 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
11233
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011234utime(<format>[,<offset>])
11235 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11236 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
11237 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11238 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11239 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11240 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
11241
11242 Example :
11243
11244 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
11245 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11246 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11247
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010011248word(<index>,<delimiters>)
11249 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
11250 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
11251
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011252wt6([<avalanche>])
11253 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
11254 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11255 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11256 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11257 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11258 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11259 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011260 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
11261 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011262
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011263xor(<value>)
11264 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
11265 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11266
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011267
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200112687.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011269--------------------------------------------
11270
11271A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11272not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11273"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11274The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11275
11276always_false : boolean
11277 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11278 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11279
11280always_true : boolean
11281 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11282 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11283
11284avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011285 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011286 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11287 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11288 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11289 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11290 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11291 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11292 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11293 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11294 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11295 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11296 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11297 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11298 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011300be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011301 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11302 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11303 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11304 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11305 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011307be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11308 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11309 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11310 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11311 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11312 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11313 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011314
11315 Example :
11316 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11317 backend dynamic
11318 mode http
11319 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11320 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011322connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11323 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011324 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011325 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11326 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011327
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011328 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011329 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011330 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11331
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011332 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11333 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011334
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011335 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011336 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011337 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011338 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11339 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011340 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011341 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011342
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011343 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11344 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011345 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011346 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011347
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011348date([<offset>]) : integer
11349 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11350 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11351 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11352 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011353 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11354
11355 Example :
11356
11357 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11358 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011359
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011360env(<name>) : string
11361 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11362 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11363 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11364 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11365 certain way.
11366
11367 Examples :
11368 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11369 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11370
11371 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11372 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011374fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11375 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011376 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11377 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011378 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11379 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11380 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11381 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11382 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011384fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11385 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11386 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11387 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11388 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11389 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11390 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11391 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11392 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011393
11394 Example :
11395 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11396 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11397 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11398 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11399 frontend mail
11400 bind :25
11401 mode tcp
11402 maxconn 100
11403 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11404 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11405 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11406 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011407
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011408nbproc : integer
11409 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11410 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11411 and debugging purposes.
11412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011413nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11414 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11415 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11416 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011417 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11418 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11419 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011420
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011421proc : integer
11422 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11423 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11424 debugging purposes.
11425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011426queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011427 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11428 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11429 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011430 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11431 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11432 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11433 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11434 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11435
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011436rand([<range>]) : integer
11437 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11438 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11439 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11440 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11441 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011443srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11444 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11445 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11446 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11447 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11448 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11449 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11450 methods.
11451
11452srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11453 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11454 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11455 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11456 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11457 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11458 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11459 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11460
11461srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11462 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11463 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011464 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011465 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11466 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11467 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11468 overloading servers).
11469
11470 Example :
11471 # Redirect to a separate back
11472 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11473 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11474 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11475
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011476stopping : boolean
11477 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11478 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11479 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011481table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11482 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11483 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11484
11485table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11486 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11487 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11488 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11489
11490
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200114917.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011492----------------------------------
11493
11494The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11495closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11496methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11497sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11498TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011499the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11500counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11501"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011502argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11503the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11504this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011505
11506be_id : integer
11507 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11508 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11509
11510dst : ip
11511 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11512 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11513 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11514 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11515 RFC 4291.
11516
11517dst_conn : integer
11518 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11519 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11520 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11521 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11522 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11523 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11524 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11525 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011527dst_port : integer
11528 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11529 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11530 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11531 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11532 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11533 an HTTP header.
11534
11535fe_id : integer
11536 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11537 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11538 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11539
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011540sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011541sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11542sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11543sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011544 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11545 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11546 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11547
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011548sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011549sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11550sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11551sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011552 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11553 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11554 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11555
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011556sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011557sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11558sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11559sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011560 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11561 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011562 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11563 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11564 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011565
11566 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11567 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011568 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11569 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11570 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011571 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11572 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11573
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011574sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011575sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11576sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11577sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011578 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11579 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11580
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011581sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011582sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11583sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11584sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011585 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11586 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11587 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11588
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011589sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011590sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11591sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11592sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011593 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11594 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11595 See also src_conn_rate.
11596
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011597sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011598sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11599sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11600sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011601 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011602 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011603
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011604sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011605sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11606sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11607sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011608 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11609 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11610 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011611 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11612 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11613 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011614
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011615sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011616sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11617sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11618sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011619 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11620 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11621 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11622
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011623sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011624sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11625sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11626sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011627 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11628 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11629 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11630 src_http_err_rate.
11631
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011632sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011633sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11634sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11635sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011636 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11637 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11638 src_http_req_cnt.
11639
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011640sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011641sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11642sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11643sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011644 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11645 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11646 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11647 src_http_req_rate.
11648
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011649sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011650sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11651sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11652sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011653 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011654 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11655 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11656 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11657 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011658
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011659 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11660 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011661 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11662
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011663sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011664sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11665sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11666sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011667 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11668 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11669 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011670
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011671sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011672sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11673sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11674sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011675 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11676 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11677 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011678
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011679sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011680sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11681sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11682sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011683 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11684 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11685 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11686 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011687 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011688 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11689
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011690sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011691sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11692sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11693sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011694 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11695 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11696 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11697 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11698 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011699 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011700
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011701sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011702sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11703sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11704sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011705 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11706 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11707 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11708
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011709sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011710sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11711sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11712sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011713 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11714 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011715 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011716 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11717 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011718 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11719 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11720 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011722so_id : integer
11723 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11724 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11725 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011727src : ip
11728 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11729 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11730 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11731 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11732 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11733 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11734 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011735
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011736 Example:
11737 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11738 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011740src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11741 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11742 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11743 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011744 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011746src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11747 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11748 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011749 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011750 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011752src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11753 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11754 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11755 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11756 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11757 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11758 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011759
11760 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11761 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11762 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11763 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011764 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011765 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11766 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011768src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011769 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011770 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011771 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011772 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011774src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011775 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011776 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11777 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011778 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011780src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11781 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11782 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11783 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011784 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011786src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011787 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011788 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011789 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011790 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011792src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011793 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011794 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011795 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11796 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011797 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11798 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11799 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011801src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11802 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11803 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011804 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011805 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011806 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011808src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11809 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11810 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11811 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11812 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011813 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011815src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11816 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11817 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11818 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011819 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011821src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11822 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11823 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11824 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011825 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011826 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011828src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11829 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11830 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11831 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011832 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011833 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11834 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011835
11836 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011837 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011838 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011840src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011841 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11842 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11843 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11844 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11845 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011847src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011848 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11849 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11850 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11851 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11852 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011854src_port : integer
11855 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11856 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11857 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11858 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011860src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11861 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011862 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11863 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11864 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011865 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011867src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11868 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11869 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11870 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11871 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011872 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011874src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11875 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11876 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11877 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11878 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11879 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11880 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11881 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11882 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011883
11884 Example :
11885 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11886 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11887 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11888 listen ssh
11889 bind :22
11890 mode tcp
11891 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011892 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011893 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011894 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011896srv_id : integer
11897 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11898 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11899 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011900
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011901
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200119027.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011903----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011905The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11906closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11907when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11908usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011909future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011910
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011911ssl_bc : boolean
11912 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11913 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11914 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11915
11916ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11917 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11918 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11919
11920ssl_bc_cipher : string
11921 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11922 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11923
11924ssl_bc_protocol : string
11925 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11926 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11927
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011928ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011929 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011930 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11931 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011932
11933ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11934 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11935 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11936 if session was reused or not.
11937
11938ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11939 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11940 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011942ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11943 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11944 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11945 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11946 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11947 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011949ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11950 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11951 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11952 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11953 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011954
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011955ssl_c_der : binary
11956 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11957 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11958 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011960ssl_c_err : integer
11961 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11962 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11963 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11964 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11965 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011967ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11968 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11969 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11970 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11971 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11972 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11973 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11974 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11975 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011977ssl_c_key_alg : string
11978 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11979 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11980 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011982ssl_c_notafter : string
11983 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11984 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11985 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011987ssl_c_notbefore : string
11988 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11989 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11990 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011992ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11993 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11994 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11995 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11996 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11997 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11998 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11999 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12000 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012002ssl_c_serial : binary
12003 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
12004 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12005 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012007ssl_c_sha1 : binary
12008 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
12009 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
12010 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020012011 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
12012 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
12013
12014 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012016ssl_c_sig_alg : string
12017 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12018 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12019 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012021ssl_c_used : boolean
12022 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
12023 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012025ssl_c_verify : integer
12026 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
12027 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
12028 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
12029 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012031ssl_c_version : integer
12032 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
12033 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012034
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012035ssl_f_der : binary
12036 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
12037 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12038 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012040ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12041 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12042 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12043 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12044 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012045 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012046 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12047 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12048 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012050ssl_f_key_alg : string
12051 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12052 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
12053 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012055ssl_f_notafter : string
12056 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12057 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12058 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012060ssl_f_notbefore : string
12061 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12062 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12063 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012065ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12066 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12067 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12068 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12069 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12070 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12071 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12072 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12073 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012075ssl_f_serial : binary
12076 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12077 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12078 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012079
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020012080ssl_f_sha1 : binary
12081 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
12082 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
12083 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
12084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012085ssl_f_sig_alg : string
12086 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12087 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12088 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012090ssl_f_version : integer
12091 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12092 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12093
12094ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012095 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12096 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
12097 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
12098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012099 Example :
12100 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
12101 listen http-https
12102 bind :80
12103 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12104 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12105
12106ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12107 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12108 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12109
12110ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012111 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012112 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12113 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12114 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12115 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12116 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12117 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12118 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12119 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012121ssl_fc_cipher : string
12122 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12123 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012125ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012126 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
12127 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010012128 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
12129 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
12130 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
12131 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012133ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
12134 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020012135 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
12136 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
12137 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12138 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012139
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020012140ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
12141 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
12142 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
12143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012144ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012145 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012146 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
12147 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
12148 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12149 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
12150 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
12151 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
12152 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020012153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012154ssl_fc_protocol : string
12155 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
12156 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012157
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012158ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012159 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012160 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12161 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012163ssl_fc_session_id : binary
12164 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
12165 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
12166 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
12167 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012169ssl_fc_sni : string
12170 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
12171 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
12172 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
12173 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
12174 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
12175
12176 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
12177 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
12178 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020012179 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12180 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012182 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012183 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
12184 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020012185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012186ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
12187 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
12188 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012189
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012190
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200121917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012192------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012194Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
12195sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
12196only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
12197For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
12198be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
12199can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
12200sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
12201for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
12202content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012204payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
12205 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
12206 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
12207 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012209payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
12210 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
12211 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
12212 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012214req.len : integer
12215req_len : integer (deprecated)
12216 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12217 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12218 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12219 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12220 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12221 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12222 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
12223 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012225req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12226 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012227 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12228 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12229 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12230 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012232 ACL alternatives :
12233 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012235req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12236 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12237 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12238 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
12239 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012241 ACL alternatives :
12242 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012244 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012246req.proto_http : boolean
12247req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
12248 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
12249 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
12250 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
12251 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
12252 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
12253 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
12254 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012256 Example:
12257 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12258 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12259 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012260 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012262req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
12263rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12264 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
12265 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
12266 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
12267 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
12268 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
12269 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
12270 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012272 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
12273 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
12274 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
12275 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
12276 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
12277 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012279 ACL derivatives :
12280 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012282 Example :
12283 listen tse-farm
12284 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
12285 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
12286 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12287 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
12288 # apply RDP cookie persistence
12289 persist rdp-cookie
12290 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
12291 # This is only useful makes sense if
12292 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
12293 stick-table type string size 204800
12294 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
12295 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
12296 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012298 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12299 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012301req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12302rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12303 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12304 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12305 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12306 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012308 ACL derivatives :
12309 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012311req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12312req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12313 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12314 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12315 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12316 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12317 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12318 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12319 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012321req.ssl_sni : string
12322req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12323 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12324 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12325 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12326 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12327 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12328 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12329 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12330 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12331 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12332 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12333 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12334 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012336 ACL derivatives :
12337 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012339 Examples :
12340 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12341 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12342 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12343 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12344 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012346res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12347rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12348 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12349 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12350 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12351 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12352 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12353 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12354 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012356req.ssl_ver : integer
12357req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12358 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12359 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12360 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12361 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12362 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12363 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12364 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12365 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12366 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012368 ACL derivatives :
12369 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012370
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012371res.len : integer
12372 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12373 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12374 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12375 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12376 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12377 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12378 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12379 content inspection.
12380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012381res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12382 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012383 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12384 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12385 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12386 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012388res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12389 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12390 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12391 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12392 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012394 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012396wait_end : boolean
12397 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12398 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12399 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12400 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12401 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12402 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12403 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12404 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012406 Examples :
12407 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12408 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12409 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012411 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12412 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12413 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12414 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12415 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12416 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12417 tcp-request content reject
12418
12419
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200124207.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012421--------------------------------------
12422
12423It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12424This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12425data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12426its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12427HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12428content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12429to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12430more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12431response are indexed.
12432
12433base : string
12434 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12435 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12436 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12437 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12438 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12439 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12440 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12441 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12442
12443 ACL derivatives :
12444 base : exact string match
12445 base_beg : prefix match
12446 base_dir : subdir match
12447 base_dom : domain match
12448 base_end : suffix match
12449 base_len : length match
12450 base_reg : regex match
12451 base_sub : substring match
12452
12453base32 : integer
12454 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12455 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12456 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012457 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12458 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12459 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012460
12461base32+src : binary
12462 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12463 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12464 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12465 per-URL counters.
12466
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012467capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12468 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12469 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12470 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12471
12472capture.req.method : string
12473 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12474 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12475 because it's allocated.
12476
12477capture.req.uri : string
12478 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12479 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12480 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12481 allocated.
12482
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012483capture.req.ver : string
12484 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12485 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12486 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12487
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012488capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12489 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12490 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12491 The first entry is an index of 0.
12492 See also: "capture response header"
12493
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012494capture.res.ver : string
12495 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12496 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12497 persistent flag.
12498
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012499req.body : binary
12500 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
12501 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12502 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
12503 the first chunk is analyzed.
12504
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020012505req.body_param([<name>) : string
12506 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
12507 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
12508 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
12509 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
12510 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
12511 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
12512 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
12513 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
12514 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
12515 given.
12516
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012517req.body_len : integer
12518 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
12519 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
12520 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12521 "option http-buffer-request".
12522
12523req.body_size : integer
12524 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
12525 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
12526 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
12527 that the request body has been buffered made available using
12528 "option http-buffer-request".
12529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012530req.cook([<name>]) : string
12531cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12532 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12533 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12534 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12535 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12536 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12537 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12538 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12539 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12540
12541 ACL derivatives :
12542 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12543 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12544 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12545 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12546 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12547 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12548 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12549 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012551req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12552cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12553 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12554 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012556req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12557cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12558 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12559 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12560 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12561 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012563cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12564 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12565 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12566 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12567 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12568 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12569 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12570 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12571 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12572 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12573 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012575hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12576 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12577 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12578 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12579 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012580 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012582req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12583 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12584 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12585 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12586 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12587 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12588 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12589 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12590 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012592req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12593 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12594 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12595 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12596 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012598req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12599 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12600 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12601 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12602 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12603 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12604 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12605 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12606 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12607 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12608 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12609 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012611 ACL derivatives :
12612 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12613 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12614 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12615 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12616 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12617 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12618 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12619 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12620
12621req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12622hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12623 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12624 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12625 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12626 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12627 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12628 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12629 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12630 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12631 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12632
12633req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12634hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12635 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12636 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12637 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12638 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12639 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12640 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12641 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12642 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12643
12644req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12645hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12646 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12647 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12648 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12649 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12650 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12651 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12652 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12653
12654http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12655 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12656 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12657 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12658 basic auth is supported.
12659
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012660http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12661 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12662 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12663 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12664 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012665 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12666 basic auth is supported.
12667
12668 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012669 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12670 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12671 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12672 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012673
12674http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012675 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12676 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012677 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12678 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012680method : integer + string
12681 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12682 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12683 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12684 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12685 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12686 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12687 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012689 ACL derivatives :
12690 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012692 Example :
12693 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12694 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12695 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012697path : string
12698 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12699 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12700 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12701 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12702 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12703 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12704 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012706 ACL derivatives :
12707 path : exact string match
12708 path_beg : prefix match
12709 path_dir : subdir match
12710 path_dom : domain match
12711 path_end : suffix match
12712 path_len : length match
12713 path_reg : regex match
12714 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012715
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012716query : string
12717 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12718 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12719 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12720 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12721 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12722 which stops before the question mark.
12723
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012724req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12725 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12726 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12727 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12728 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012730req.ver : string
12731req_ver : string (deprecated)
12732 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12733 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12734 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012736 ACL derivatives :
12737 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012739res.comp : boolean
12740 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12741 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12742 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012744res.comp_algo : string
12745 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12746 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12747 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012749res.cook([<name>]) : string
12750scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12751 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12752 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12753 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012755 ACL derivatives :
12756 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012758res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12759scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12760 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12761 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12762 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012764res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12765scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12766 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12767 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12768 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012770res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12771 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12772 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12773 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12774 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12775 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12776 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12777 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12778 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12779 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012781res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12782 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12783 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12784 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12785 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12786 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012788res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12789shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12790 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12791 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12792 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12793 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12794 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12795 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12796 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12797 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012799 ACL derivatives :
12800 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12801 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12802 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12803 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12804 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12805 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12806 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12807 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12808
12809res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12810shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12811 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12812 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12813 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12814 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12815 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012817res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12818shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12819 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12820 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12821 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12822 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12823 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12824 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012825
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012826res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12827 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12828 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12829 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12830 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012832res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12833shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12834 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12835 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12836 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12837 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12838 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12839 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012841res.ver : string
12842resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12843 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12844 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012846 ACL derivatives :
12847 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012849set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12850 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12851 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12852 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12853 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012855 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12856 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012858 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012860status : integer
12861 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12862 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12863 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012865url : string
12866 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12867 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12868 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12869 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12870 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12871 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12872 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012874 ACL derivatives :
12875 url : exact string match
12876 url_beg : prefix match
12877 url_dir : subdir match
12878 url_dom : domain match
12879 url_end : suffix match
12880 url_len : length match
12881 url_reg : regex match
12882 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012884url_ip : ip
12885 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12886 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12887 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12888 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12889 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12890 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12891 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012893url_port : integer
12894 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12895 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12896 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12897 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012898
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020012899urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
12900url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012901 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12902 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020012903 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
12904 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
12905 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
12906 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012907 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12908 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020012909 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
12910 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012912 ACL derivatives :
12913 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12914 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12915 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12916 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12917 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12918 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12919 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12920 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012921
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012923 Example :
12924 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12925 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12926 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12927 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012928
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020012929urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012930 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12931 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12932 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012933
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129357.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012936---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012938Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12939every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012940order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012942ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12943---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012944FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012945HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012946HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12947HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012948HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12949HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12950HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12951HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12952LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012953METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12954METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12955METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12956METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12957METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12958METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012959RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012960REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012961TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012962WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12963---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012964
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129668. Logging
12967----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012968
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012969One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12970provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12971very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12972provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12973state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012974to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012975headers.
12976
12977In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12978about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12979send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12980
12981 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12982 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12983 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12984 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12985 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060012986 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
12987 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012988
12989The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12990allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12991as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12992while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12993real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12994delay.
12995
12996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129978.1. Log levels
12998---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012999
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013000TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013001source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013002HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
13003in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
13004track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
13005syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
13006about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013007
13008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130098.2. Log formats
13010----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013011
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013012HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013013and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
13014slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
13015options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013016
13017 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
13018 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
13019 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
13020 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
13021 extents.
13022
13023 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
13024 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
13025 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
13026 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
13027 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
13028
13029 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
13030 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
13031 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
13032 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
13033 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
13034
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020013035 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
13036 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
13037 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
13038 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
13039
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013040 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
13041
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013042Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
13043specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
13044field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
13045servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
13046always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
13047identifier.
13048
13049Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
13050 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
13051 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
13052 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
13053 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
13054
13055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130568.2.1. Default log format
13057-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013058
13059This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
13060as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
13061format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
13062
13063 Example :
13064 listen www
13065 mode http
13066 log global
13067 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13068
13069 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
13070 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
13071 (www/HTTP)
13072
13073 Field Format Extract from the example above
13074 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
13075 2 'Connect from' Connect from
13076 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
13077 4 'to' to
13078 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
13079 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
13080
13081Detailed fields description :
13082 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
13083 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
13084 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
13085 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
13086 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13087 and processed the connection.
13088 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
13089
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013090In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
13091"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
13092connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
13093
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013094It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
13095will eventually disappear.
13096
13097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130988.2.2. TCP log format
13099---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013100
13101The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
13102is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
13103information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
13104counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
13105emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13106environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13107the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13108sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013109specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
13110not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
13111fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
13112marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013113
13114 Example :
13115 frontend fnt
13116 mode tcp
13117 option tcplog
13118 log global
13119 default_backend bck
13120
13121 backend bck
13122 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13123
13124 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
13125 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
13126 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
13127
13128 Field Format Extract from the example above
13129 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
13130 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
13131 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
13132 4 frontend_name fnt
13133 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
13134 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
13135 7 bytes_read* 212
13136 8 termination_state --
13137 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
13138 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13139
13140Detailed fields description :
13141 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013142 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13143 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13144 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13145 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13146 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013147
13148 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013149 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13150 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13151 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013152
13153 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
13154 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
13155 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
13156 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
13157
13158 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13159 and processed the connection.
13160
13161 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13162 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13163 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
13164 applications.
13165
13166 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13167 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13168 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13169 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
13170 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
13171
13172 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13173 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13174 See "Timers" below for more details.
13175
13176 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13177 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13178 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
13179 "Timers" below for more details.
13180
13181 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013182 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013183 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13184 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13185 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13186 details.
13187
13188 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
13189 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
13190 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
13191 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
13192 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
13193
13194 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13195 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13196 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
13197 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
13198 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
13199 for more details.
13200
13201 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013202 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013203 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
13204 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
13205 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013206 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013207
13208 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13209 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13210 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13211 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13212 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13213 caused by a denial of service attack.
13214
13215 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13216 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13217 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13218 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13219 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13220 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13221 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13222 denial of service attack.
13223
13224 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13225 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13226 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13227 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13228 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13229 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13230 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13231 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
13232 be processed than on other servers.
13233
13234 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13235 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13236 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13237 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13238 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13239 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13240 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13241 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13242 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13243 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13244 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13245 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13246 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13247
13248 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13249 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13250 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13251 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13252 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13253 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13254 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13255 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13256
13257 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13258 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13259 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13260 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13261 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13262 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13263 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13264 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13265 occurs.
13266
13267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132688.2.3. HTTP log format
13269----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013270
13271The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
13272is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
13273the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
13274are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
13275emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
13276generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
13277"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
13278which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013279frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
13280is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013281
13282Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
13283slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
13284with a star ('*') after the field name below.
13285
13286 Example :
13287 frontend http-in
13288 mode http
13289 option httplog
13290 log global
13291 default_backend bck
13292
13293 backend static
13294 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13295
13296 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
13297 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
13298 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013299 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013300
13301 Field Format Extract from the example above
13302 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
13303 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
13304 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
13305 4 frontend_name http-in
13306 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
13307 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
13308 7 status_code 200
13309 8 bytes_read* 2750
13310 9 captured_request_cookie -
13311 10 captured_response_cookie -
13312 11 termination_state ----
13313 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
13314 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13315 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
13316 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
13317 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013318
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013319
13320Detailed fields description :
13321 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013322 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13323 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13324 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13325 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13326 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013327
13328 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013329 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13330 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13331 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013332
13333 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13334 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13335 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13336 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13337 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13338
13339 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13340 and processed the connection.
13341
13342 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13343 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13344 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13345
13346 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13347 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13348 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13349 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13350 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13351 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13352
13353 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13354 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13355 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13356 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13357 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13358 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13359
13360 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13361 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13362 See "Timers" below for more details.
13363
13364 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13365 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13366 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13367 below for more details.
13368
13369 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13370 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13371 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13372 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13373 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13374 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13375 for more details.
13376
13377 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013378 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013379 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13380 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13381 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13382 details.
13383
13384 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13385 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13386 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13387
13388 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13389 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13390 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13391 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13392 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13393 overflowing.
13394
13395 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13396 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13397 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13398 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13399 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13400 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13401 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13402 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13403
13404 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13405 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13406 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13407 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13408 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13409 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13410 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13411 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13412
13413 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13414 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13415 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13416 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13417 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13418 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13419 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13420
13421 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013422 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013423 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13424 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13425 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013426 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013427 system.
13428
13429 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13430 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13431 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13432 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13433 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13434 caused by a denial of service attack.
13435
13436 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13437 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13438 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13439 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13440 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13441 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13442 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13443 denial of service attack.
13444
13445 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13446 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13447 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13448 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13449 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13450 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13451 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13452 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13453 processed than on other servers.
13454
13455 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13456 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13457 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13458 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13459 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13460 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13461 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13462 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13463 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13464 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13465 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13466 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13467 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13468
13469 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13470 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13471 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13472 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13473 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13474 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13475 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13476 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13477
13478 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13479 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13480 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13481 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13482 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13483 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13484 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13485 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13486 occurs.
13487
13488 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13489 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13490 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13491 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13492 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13493 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13494 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13495 cookies" below for more details.
13496
13497 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13498 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13499 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13500 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13501 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13502 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13503 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13504 and cookies" below for more details.
13505
13506 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13507 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13508 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13509 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13510 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13511 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13512 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13513 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13514
13515
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200135168.2.4. Custom log format
13517------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013518
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013519The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013520mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013521
13522HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13523Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13524separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13525prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13526
13527Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13528variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13529string formats ("Q").
13530
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013531If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013532as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013533less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13534the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13535
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013536Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013537In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013538in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013539
13540Flags are :
13541 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013542 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013543
13544 Example:
13545
13546 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13547 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13548
13549At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13550
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013551 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13552 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013553
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013554the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013555
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013556 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013557 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013558 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013559
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013560and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13561
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013562 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013563 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13564
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013565Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13566
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013567 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013568 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013569 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13570 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13571 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013572 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13573 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13574 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013575 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000013576 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
13577 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
13578 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
13579 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013580 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013581 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013582 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013583 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013584 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013585 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13586 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013587 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013588 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13589 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013590 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013591 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13592 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013593 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13594 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13595 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013596 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013597 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13598 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013599 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013600 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13601 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13602 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013603 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013604 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013605 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13606 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13607 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13608 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013609 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013610 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013611 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013612 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013613 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013614 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013615 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13616 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13617 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013618 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013619 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13620 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013621 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013622 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013623 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013624 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013625
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013626 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013627
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013628
136298.2.5. Error log format
13630-----------------------
13631
13632When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13633protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13634By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13635"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13636will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13637logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13638
13639The format looks like this :
13640
13641 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13642 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13643 Connection error during SSL handshake
13644
13645 Field Format Extract from the example above
13646 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13647 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13648 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13649 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13650 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13651
13652These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13653failures.
13654
13655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136568.3. Advanced logging options
13657-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013658
13659Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13660just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13661options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13662for more information about their usage.
13663
13664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136658.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13666------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013667
13668It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13669haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13670commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13671monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13672ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13673
13674 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13675 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13676 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13677 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13678
13679 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13680 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13681 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013682 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013683 such as other load-balancers.
13684
13685 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13686 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13687 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13688
13689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13691----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013692
13693The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13694what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13695or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13696"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13697just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13698log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13699after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13700is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13701with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13702with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13703
13704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13706------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013707
13708Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13709for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13710"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13711retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13712raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13713a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13714file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13715you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13716"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13717
13718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137198.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13720--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013721
13722Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13723multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13724them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13725"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13726logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13727error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13728and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13729too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13730useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13731alternative.
13732
13733
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137348.4. Timing events
13735------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013736
13737Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13738reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13739the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13740frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13741mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13742
13743 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13744 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13745 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13746 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13747 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13748
13749 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13750 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13751 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13752 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13753 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13754
13755 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13756 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13757 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13758 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13759 connection never established.
13760
13761 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13762 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13763 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13764 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13765 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13766 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13767 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13768 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13769 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13770 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13771 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13772
13773 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13774 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13775 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13776 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013777 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013778
13779 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13780
13781 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13782 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13783 negative.
13784
13785These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13786protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13787that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013788due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013789close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13790session has been aborted on timeout.
13791
13792Most common cases :
13793
13794 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13795 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13796 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13797 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13798 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13799 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13800 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13801 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13802 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013803 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13804 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13805 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013806
13807 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13808 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13809 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13810 of ms on remote networks.
13811
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013812 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13813 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13814 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013815
13816 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13817 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13818 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13819 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13820 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13821 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13822 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13823 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13824 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13825 to the server until another one is released.
13826
13827Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13828
13829 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13830 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13831 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13832
13833 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13834 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13835 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13836
13837 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13838 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13839 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13840 flags.
13841
13842 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13843 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13844 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13845 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13846 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13847 the client connection was maintained open.
13848
13849 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013850 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013851 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13852 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13853
13854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138558.5. Session state at disconnection
13856-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013857
13858TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13859"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
138602-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13861each of which has a special meaning :
13862
13863 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13864 session to terminate :
13865
13866 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13867
13868 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13869 server explicitly refused it.
13870
13871 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13872 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13873 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13874 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013875 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13876
13877 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13878 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013879
13880 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13881 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13882 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13883 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13884 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13885
13886 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13887 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13888 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13889 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13890 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13891
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013892 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13893 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13894
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013895 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13896 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13897 backup connections when going up.
13898
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013899 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13900
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013901 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13902 send or receive data.
13903
13904 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13905 send or receive data.
13906
13907 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13908 with nothing left in the buffers.
13909
13910 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13911
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013912 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013913 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13914
13915 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13916 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13917 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13918 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13919 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13920
13921 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13922 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13923
13924 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13925 server (HTTP only).
13926
13927 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13928
13929 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13930 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13931 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13932
13933 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13934 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13935 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13936
13937 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13938
13939 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13940 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13941
13942 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13943 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13944 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13945
13946 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13947 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013948 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13949 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013950
13951 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13952 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13953 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13954 another server.
13955
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013956 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013957 server.
13958
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013959 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13960 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13961 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13962 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13963
13964 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13965 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13966 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13967 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13968
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013969 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13970 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13971 "use-server" rule).
13972
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013973 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13974
13975 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13976 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13977
13978 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13979
13980 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13981 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13982 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13983
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013984 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13985 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013986 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013987 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13988 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13989
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013990 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13991
13992 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13993 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13994
13995 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13996
13997 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13998
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013999The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
14000was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014001helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
14002starvation, attacks, etc...
14003
14004The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
14005alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
14006easier finding and understanding.
14007
14008 Flags Reason
14009
14010 -- Normal termination.
14011
14012 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
14013 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
14014 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
14015 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
14016
14017 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
14018 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
14019 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
14020 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
14021 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
14022 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014023
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014024 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14025 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014026 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014027
14028 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
14029 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
14030 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
14031
14032 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
14033 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
14034 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
14035 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
14036 the server takes too long to respond.
14037
14038 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
14039 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
14040 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
14041 long a time to respond.
14042
14043 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
14044 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
14045 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
14046 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014047 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
14048 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014049
14050 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
14051 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
14052 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
14053 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
14054 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014055 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014056 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
14057 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
14058 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
14059 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
14060 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
14061 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
14062 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
14063 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
14064 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
14065 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
14066 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
14067 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014068
14069 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
14070 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014071 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
14072 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
14073 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
14074 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014075
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014076 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
14077 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
14078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014079 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014080 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
14081 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
14082 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
14083 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
14084 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
14085
14086 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
14087 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
14088 503 or 504 here.
14089
14090 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
14091 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
14092 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
14093 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
14094 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
14095
14096 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14097 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014098 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014099 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
14100 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
14101
14102 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
14103 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
14104 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
14105 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14106 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14107 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14108 between haproxy and the server.
14109
14110 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
14111 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
14112 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
14113 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
14114 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
14115 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
14116 solution is to fix the application.
14117
14118 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
14119 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
14120 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
14121 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
14122 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
14123 external attacks.
14124
14125 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
14126 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014127 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014128 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
14129 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
14130
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014131 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
14132 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
14133 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020014134 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
14135 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014136
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014137 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
14138 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
14139 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
14140 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014141 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
14142 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
14143 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
14144 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
14145 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014146
14147 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
14148 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
14149 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
14150 returned an HTTP 403 error.
14151
14152 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
14153 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
14154 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
14155 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
14156
14157 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
14158 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
14159 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
14160 only be solved by proper system tuning.
14161
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014162The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
14163persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
14164important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
14165re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
14166
14167 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
14168
14169 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14170 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
14171 set on a GET request.
14172
14173 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
14174 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014175 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014176 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
14177
14178 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
14179 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
14180 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
14181
14182 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14183 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
14184 already got a cookie.
14185
14186 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14187 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
14188 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
14189 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
14190 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
14191
14192 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14193 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14194 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14195
14196 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
14197 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14198 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14199
14200 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
14201 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
14202
14203 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
14204 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
14205 then advertised in the response.
14206
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142088.6. Non-printable characters
14209-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014210
14211In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
14212consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
14213converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
14214prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
14215being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
14216escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
14217is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
14218'}' when logging headers.
14219
14220Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
14221issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
14222containing spaces is "User-Agent".
14223
14224Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
14225the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
14226performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
14227
14228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142298.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
14230---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014231
14232Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
14233achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014234section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014235cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
14236the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
14237the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014238locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014239not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
14240user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
14241a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
14242wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
14243
14244 Examples :
14245 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
14246 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
14247
14248 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
14249 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
14250
14251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142528.8. Capturing HTTP headers
14253---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014254
14255Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
14256proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
14257the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
14258server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
14259
14260Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
14261response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014262section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014263
14264It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014265time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
14266appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014267are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
14268and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
14269follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
14270request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
14271in the logs.
14272
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014273As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
14274frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
14275an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
14276
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014277 Example :
14278 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
14279 listen proxy-out
14280 mode http
14281 option httplog
14282 option logasap
14283 log global
14284 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
14285
14286 # log the name of the virtual server
14287 capture request header Host len 20
14288
14289 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
14290 capture request header Content-Length len 10
14291
14292 # log the beginning of the referrer
14293 capture request header Referer len 20
14294
14295 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
14296 capture response header Server len 20
14297
14298 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
14299 capture response header Content-Length len 10
14300
14301 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
14302 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
14303
14304 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
14305 capture response header Via len 20
14306
14307 # log the URL location during a redirection
14308 capture response header Location len 20
14309
14310 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
14311 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
14312 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14313 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
14314 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
14315
14316 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14317 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14318 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14319 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014320 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014321
14322 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14323 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14324 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14325 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
14326 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014327 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014328
14329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143308.9. Examples of logs
14331---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014332
14333These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14334them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14335reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14336
14337 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14338 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14339 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14340
14341 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14342 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14343
14344 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14345 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14346 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14347
14348 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14349 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14350
14351 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14352 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14353 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14354
14355 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014356 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014357 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14358 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14359
14360 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14361 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14362 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14363
14364 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14365 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014366 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014367 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14368 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14369 to return the 502 and not the server.
14370
14371 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014372 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014373
14374 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14375 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14376 Nothing was sent to any server.
14377
14378 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14379 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14380
14381 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14382 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14383 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14384 send a 408 return code to the client.
14385
14386 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14387 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14388
14389 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14390 5 seconds ("c----").
14391
14392 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14393 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014394 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014395
14396 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014397 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014398 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14399 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14400 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14401 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14402 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014403
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144059. Statistics and monitoring
14406----------------------------
14407
14408It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14409mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14410CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14411Unix socket.
14412
14413
144149.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014415---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014416
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014417The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014418page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14419begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14420represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14421use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14422('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14423(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14424text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14425do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14426use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014427
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014428In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14429that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14430S (Servers).
14431
14432 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14433 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14434 any name for server/listener)
14435 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14436 number queued without a server assigned.
14437 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14438 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14439 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14440 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14441 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14442 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14443 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14444 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14445 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14446 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14447 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14448 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14449 "option checkcache".
14450 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14451 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14452 - read error from the client
14453 - client timeout
14454 - client closed connection
14455 - various bad requests from the client.
14456 - request was tarpitted.
14457 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14458 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14459 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14460 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14461 active servers).
14462 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14463 Some other errors are:
14464 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14465 - failure applying filters to the response.
14466 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14467 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14468 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14469 switched away from.
14470 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissis1f673c72015-05-02 20:30:44 +020014471 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
14472 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
14473 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014474 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14475 the server is up.)
14476 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14477 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14478 counters for each server.
14479 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14480 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14481 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14482 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14483 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14484 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14485 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14486 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14487 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14488 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14489 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14490 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14491 of times that server was selected.
14492 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14493 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14494 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14495 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14496 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14497 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014498 UNK -> unknown
14499 INI -> initializing
14500 SOCKERR -> socket error
14501 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014502 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014503 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14504 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14505 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14506 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14507 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14508 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14509 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14510 disable-on-404
14511 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14512 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14513 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014514 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14515 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14516 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14517 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14518 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14519 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14520 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14521 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14522 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14523 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14524 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14525 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14526 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14527 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14528 (inc. in eresp)
14529 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14530 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14531 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14532 (CPU/BW limit)
14533 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14534 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14535 server/backend
14536 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14537 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14538 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14539 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14540 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14541 (0 for TCP)
14542 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14543 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014544
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145469.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014547-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014548
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014549The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14550necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14551A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14552issuing commands by hand :
14553
14554 global
14555 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14556 stats timeout 2m
14557
14558It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14559the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14560never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14561situations :
14562
14563 global
14564 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14565 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14566 stats timeout 2m
14567
14568To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14569swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14570to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14571syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14572
14573 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14574 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14575
14576The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14577script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14578for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14579
14580The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14581that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14582editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14583(eg: watch a counter).
14584
14585The socket supports two operation modes :
14586 - interactive
14587 - non-interactive
14588
14589The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14590this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14591sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14592mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14593commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14594example :
14595
14596 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14597
14598The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14599entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14600for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14601sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14602"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14603after processing the last command of the same line.
14604
14605For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14606"prompt" command :
14607
14608 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14609 prompt
14610 > show info
14611 ...
14612 >
14613
14614Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14615delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14616that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14617parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014618
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014619It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14620on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14621own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014622
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014623The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14624If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14625all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14626it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14627
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014628add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014629 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14630 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14631 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14632 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014633
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014634add map <map> <key> <value>
14635 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14636 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014637 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14638 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14639 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014640
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014641clear counters
14642 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14643 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14644 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14645 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14646 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14647
14648clear counters all
14649 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14650 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14651 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14652
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014653clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014654 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14655 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14656 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014657
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014658clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014659 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14660 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14661 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014662
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014663clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14664 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14665
14666 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14667 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14668 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14669 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14670 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14671 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14672
14673 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14674
14675 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14676 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14677 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14678 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14679 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14680 the ACLs :
14681
14682 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14683 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14684 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14685 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14686 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14687 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14688
14689 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014690 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14691 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014692
14693 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014694 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014695 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014696 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14697 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14698 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14699 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014700
14701 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14702
14703 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014704 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014705 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14706 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014707 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14708 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14709 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014710
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014711del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14712 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014713 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14714 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14715 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14716 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014717
14718del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014719 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014720 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14721 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14722 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14723 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014724
14725disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014726 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14727
14728 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14729 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14730 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14731 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14732 re-enabled using enable agent.
14733
14734 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14735 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14736 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14737 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14738 otherwise unchanged.
14739
14740 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14741 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14742 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14743
14744 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14745 level "admin".
14746
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014747disable frontend <frontend>
14748 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14749 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14750 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14751 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14752 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14753 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14754 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14755 on the stats page.
14756
14757 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14758 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14759
14760 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14761 level "admin".
14762
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014763disable health <backend>/<server>
14764 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14765 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14766 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14767 agent check forces it down.
14768
14769 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14770 level "admin".
14771
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014772disable server <backend>/<server>
14773 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14774 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14775 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14776 during the maintenance.
14777
14778 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14779 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14780
14781 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014782 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014783
14784 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14785 level "admin".
14786
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014787enable agent <backend>/<server>
14788 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14789
14790 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14791 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14792
14793 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14794 level "admin".
14795
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014796enable frontend <frontend>
14797 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14798 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14799 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14800 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14801 which was disabled.
14802
14803 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14804 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14805
14806 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14807 level "admin".
14808
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014809enable health <backend>/<server>
14810 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14811 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14812
14813 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14814 level "admin".
14815
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014816enable server <backend>/<server>
14817 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14818 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14819
14820 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014821 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014822
14823 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14824 level "admin".
14825
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014826get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014827get acl <acl> <value>
14828 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14829 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14830 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14831 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14832 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014833
14834 The first two words are:
14835
14836 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14837 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14838 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14839
14840 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14841
14842 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14843
14844 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14845
14846 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14847 interpretation of the case.
14848
14849 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14850 useful with regular expressions.
14851
14852 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14853 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14854
14855 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14856 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14857 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14858
14859 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14860
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014861get weight <backend>/<server>
14862 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14863 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14864 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14865 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14866 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014867 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014868
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014869help
14870 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14871 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014872
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014873prompt
14874 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14875 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14876 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14877 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14878 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14879 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14880 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14881 command.
14882
14883quit
14884 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014885
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014886set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014887 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14888 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14889 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014890
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014891set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014892 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14893 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14894 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14895 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14896 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014897 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14898 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14899
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014900set maxconn global <maxconn>
14901 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14902 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14903 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14904 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14905 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14906 setting.
14907
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014908set rate-limit connections global <value>
14909 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14910 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14911 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14912 is passed in number of connections per second.
14913
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014914set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14915 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14916 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014917 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14918 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014919
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014920set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14921 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14922 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14923 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14924 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14925
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014926set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14927 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14928 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14929 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14930 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14931 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14932
Baptiste Assmann3d8f8312015-04-13 22:54:33 +020014933set server <backend>/<server> addr <ip4 or ip6 address>
14934 Replace the current IP address of a server by the one provided.
14935
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014936set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14937 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14938 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14939 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14940
14941set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14942 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14943 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14944 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14945
14946set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14947 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14948 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14949 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14950 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14951 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14952 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14953 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14954 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14955
14956set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14957 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14958 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14959
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014960set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14961 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14962 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14963 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14964 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14965
14966 Example:
14967 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14968 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14969 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14970 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14971
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020014972set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
14973 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
14974 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
14975 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
14976 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
14977 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
14978
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014979set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014980 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14981 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14982 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14983 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014984 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14985 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014986
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014987set timeout cli <delay>
14988 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14989 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14990 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14991
14992set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14993 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14994 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014995 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14996 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14997 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14998 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14999 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
15000 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
15001 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
15002 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
15003 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
15004 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
15005 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
15006 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
15007 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015008
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015009show errors [<iid>]
15010 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
15011 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015012 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
15013 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
15014 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015015
15016 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
15017 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
15018 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
15019 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
15020 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
15021 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
15022 are reported too.
15023
15024 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
15025 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
15026 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
15027 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
15028 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
15029 code.
15030
15031 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
15032 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
15033 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
15034 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
15035 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
15036 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
15037 line.
15038
15039 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015040 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15041 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015042 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
15043 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
15044
15045 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
15046 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
15047 00038 Location: blah\r\n
15048 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
15049 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
15050 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
15051 00204+ minal\r\n
15052 00211 \r\n
15053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015054 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015055 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
15056 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
15057 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
15058 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
15059 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
15060 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015061
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015062show info
15063 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
15064
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015065show map [<map>]
15066 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015067 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
15068 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
15069 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
15070 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
15071 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
15072 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015073
15074show acl [<acl>]
15075 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015076 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
15077 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
15078 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
15079 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
15080 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015081
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010015082show pools
15083 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
15084 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
15085 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
15086 the pools.
15087
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015088show sess
15089 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015090 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
15091 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15092
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010015093show sess <id>
15094 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
15095 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15096 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
15097 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
15098 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020015099 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
15100 returned in src/dumpstats.c
15101
15102 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
15103 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015104
15105show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
15106 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
15107 possible to dump only selected items :
15108 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
15109 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
15110 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
15111 for example:
15112 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
15113 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
15114 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
15115
15116 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015117 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
15118 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015119 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
15120 Release_date: 2009/09/23
15121 Nbproc: 1
15122 Process_num: 1
15123 (...)
15124
15125 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
15126 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
15127 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
15128 (...)
15129 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
15130
15131 $
15132
15133 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
15134 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
15135 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
15136 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015137 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015138
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015139show table
15140 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
15141 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
15142 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
15143 entries currently in use.
15144
15145 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015146 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015147 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
15148 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015149
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015150show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015151 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
15152 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
15153 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015154 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
15155
15156 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
15157 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
15158 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
15159 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
15160 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
15161
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015162 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15163 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15164 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15165 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15166 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15167 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15168
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015169
15170 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015171 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
15172 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015173
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015174 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015175 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015176 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015177 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15178 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15179 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15180 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015181
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015182 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015183 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015184 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15185 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015186
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015187 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
15188 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015189 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015190 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15191 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015192
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015193 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
15194 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015195 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015196 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15197 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
15198
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015199 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
15200 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
15201 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
15202 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
15203 time goes, the average event rate drops.
15204
15205 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
15206 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
15207 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015208 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
15209 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015210 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
15211 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020015212
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015213show tls-keys
15214 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
15215 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
15216 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
15217
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015218shutdown frontend <frontend>
15219 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
15220 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
15221 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
15222 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
15223 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
15224 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
15225 once it is terminated.
15226
15227 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15228 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15229
15230 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15231 level "admin".
15232
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020015233shutdown session <id>
15234 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
15235 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15236 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
15237 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
15238 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
15239 flag in the logs.
15240
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020015241shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015242 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
15243 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
15244 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
15245 'K' flag in the logs.
15246
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015247/*
15248 * Local variables:
15249 * fill-column: 79
15250 * End:
15251 */